blob: 4d250155dc3834b8aab4040d5fdff32580b4387f [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau16216822012-09-10 09:46:55 +02007 2012/09/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100627. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200637.1. Matching integers
647.2. Matching strings
657.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200667.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200677.5. Available matching criteria
687.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
697.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
707.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
717.6. Pre-defined ACLs
727.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100737.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074
758. Logging
768.1. Log levels
778.2. Log formats
788.2.1. Default log format
798.2.2. TCP log format
808.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100818.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200828.3. Advanced logging options
838.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
848.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
878.4. Timing events
888.5. Session state at disconnection
898.6. Non-printable characters
908.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
918.8. Capturing HTTP headers
928.9. Examples of logs
93
949. Statistics and monitoring
959.1. CSV format
969.2. Unix Socket commands
97
98
991. Quick reminder about HTTP
100----------------------------
101
102When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
103fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
104on almost anything found in the contents.
105
106However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
107formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
108correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
109
110
1111.1. The HTTP transaction model
112-------------------------------
113
114The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100115to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
117connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
118will involve a new connection :
119
120 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
121
122In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
123establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
124by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
125length.
126
127Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
128to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
129however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
130response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
131header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
132
133 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
134
135Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
136power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
137but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200138a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200139
140A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
141keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
142second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
143page :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
148latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
149correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
150the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100151server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200153By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
154connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
155everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
156established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
157sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
158while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
159another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
160sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
161http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
162mode.
163
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
1651.2. HTTP request
166-----------------
167
168First, let's consider this HTTP request :
169
170 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100171 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
173 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
174 3 User-agent: my small browser
175 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
176 5 Accept: image/png
177
178
1791.2.1. The Request line
180-----------------------
181
182Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
183
184 - a METHOD : GET
185 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
186 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
187
188All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
189which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
190followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
191is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
192desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
193the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
194
195The URI itself can have several forms :
196
197 - A "relative URI" :
198
199 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200
201 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
202 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
203
204 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
205
206 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
207
208 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
209 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
210 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
211 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
212 must accept this form too.
213
214 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
215 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
216 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
219 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
220 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
221 other protocols too.
222
223In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
224mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
225on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
226It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
227specific to the language, framework or application in use.
228
229
2301.2.2. The request headers
231--------------------------
232
233The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
234beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
235an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
236Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
237values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
238encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
239the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
240define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
241
242Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
243their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
244"Connection:" header).
245
246The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
247that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
248is one valid form of empty line.
249
250Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
251headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
252about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
253application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
254
255Important note:
256 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
257 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
258 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
259 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
260
261
2621.3. HTTP response
263------------------
264
265An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
266messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
267
268 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100269 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
271 2 Content-length: 350
272 3 Content-Type: text/html
273
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200274As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
275codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
276response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100277continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
278the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
279following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
280sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
281(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
282correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
283such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
284state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
285over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
286if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
287information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289
2901.3.1. The Response line
291------------------------
292
293Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
294
295 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
296 - a status code : 200
297 - a reason : OK
298
299The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200300 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
302 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
303 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
304 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
305
306Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100307"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
309messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
310or "Authentication Required".
311
312Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
313
314 Code When / reason
315 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
316 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
318 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
319 400 for an invalid or too large request
320 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
321 accessing the stats page)
322 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
323 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
324 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
325 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
326 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
327 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
328 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
329 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
330 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
331
332The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3334.2).
334
335
3361.3.2. The response headers
337---------------------------
338
339Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
340the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
341details.
342
343
3442. Configuring HAProxy
345----------------------
346
3472.1. Configuration file format
348------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200349
350HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
351
352 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
353 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
354 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
355 "frontend" and "backend".
356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
358referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
359delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100360preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100361escaped by doubling them.
362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363
3642.2. Time format
365----------------
366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100367Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100368values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
369otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
370numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
371for every keyword. Supported units are :
372
373 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
374 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
375 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
376 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
377 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
378 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
379
380
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003812.3. Examples
382-------------
383
384 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
385 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
386 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
387 global
388 daemon
389 maxconn 256
390
391 defaults
392 mode http
393 timeout connect 5000ms
394 timeout client 50000ms
395 timeout server 50000ms
396
397 frontend http-in
398 bind *:80
399 default_backend servers
400
401 backend servers
402 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
403
404
405 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
406 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
407 global
408 daemon
409 maxconn 256
410
411 defaults
412 mode http
413 timeout connect 5000ms
414 timeout client 50000ms
415 timeout server 50000ms
416
417 listen http-in
418 bind *:80
419 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
420
421
422Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
423
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100424 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200425
426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004273. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200428--------------------
429
430Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
431are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
432of them have command-line equivalents.
433
434The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
435
436 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200437 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200439 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200440 - daemon
441 - gid
442 - group
443 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100444 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200445 - nbproc
446 - pidfile
447 - uid
448 - ulimit-n
449 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200450 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200451 - node
452 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100453 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100454
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 * Performance tuning
456 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200457 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100458 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100459 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200460 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200461 - noepoll
462 - nokqueue
463 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100464 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200465 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200466 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200467 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100468 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200469 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100470 - tune.maxaccept
471 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200472 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200473 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100474 - tune.rcvbuf.client
475 - tune.rcvbuf.server
476 - tune.sndbuf.client
477 - tune.sndbuf.server
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100478 - tune.zlib.memlevel
479 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100480
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200481 * Debugging
482 - debug
483 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200484
485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004863.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200487------------------------------------
488
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200489ca-base <dir>
490 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200491 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
492 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200493
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200494chroot <jail dir>
495 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
496 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
497 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
498 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
499 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
500 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100501
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200502crt-base <dir>
503 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
504 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
505 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
506
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507daemon
508 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
509 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
510 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
511
512gid <number>
513 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
514 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
515 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
516 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518group <group name>
519 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
520 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100521
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200522log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200523 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
524 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100525 configured with "log global".
526
527 <address> can be one of:
528
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100529 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100530 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
531 port).
532
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100533 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
534 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
535 port).
536
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100537 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
538 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
539 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
540 writeable).
541
542 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200543
544 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
545 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
546 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
547
548 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200549 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
550 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
551 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
552 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
553 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
554 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200555
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200556 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100558log-send-hostname [<string>]
559 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
560 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
561 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
562 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
563 the logs.
564
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000565log-tag <string>
566 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
567 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
568 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
569 running on the same host.
570
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200571nbproc <number>
572 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
573 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
574 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
575 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
576 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
577
578pidfile <pidfile>
579 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
580 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
581 starting the process. See also "daemon".
582
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100583stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200584 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
585 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
586 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
587 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
588 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
589 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
590 the number of processes used.
591
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200592stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
593 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
594 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
595 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
596 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200597
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200598 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
599 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
600 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200601
602stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
603 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
604 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100605 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200606
607stats maxconn <connections>
608 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
609 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
610
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611uid <number>
612 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
613 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
614 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
615 one. See also "gid" and "user".
616
617ulimit-n <number>
618 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
619 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
620 option.
621
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100622unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
623 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
624
625 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
626 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
627 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
628 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
629 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
630 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
631 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
632 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
633 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
634 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
635
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636user <user name>
637 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
638 See also "uid" and "group".
639
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200640node <name>
641 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
642
643 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
644 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
645 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
646 traffic.
647
648description <text>
649 Add a text that describes the instance.
650
651 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
652 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
653 "<" and ">" characters.
654
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006563.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200657-----------------------
658
659maxconn <number>
660 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
661 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
662 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
663 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
664
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200665maxconnrate <number>
666 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
667 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
668 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
669 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
670 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
671 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
672 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
673 fairness.
674
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100675maxcomprate <number>
676 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
677 pers second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
678 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
679 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
680 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
681 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
682 default value.
683
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100684maxpipes <number>
685 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
686 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
687 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
688 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
689 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
690 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
691
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200692maxsslconn <number>
693 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
694 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
695 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
696 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
697 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
698 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
699 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
700
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100701maxzlibmem <number>
702 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
703 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
704 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
705 The default value is 0.
706
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200707noepoll
708 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
709 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100710 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200711
712nokqueue
713 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
714 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
715 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
716
717nopoll
718 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
719 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100720 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100721 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100723nosplice
724 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
725 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
726 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100727 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100728 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
729 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
730 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
731 "option splice-response".
732
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200733spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
734 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
735 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
736 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
737 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
738 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
739
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200740tune.bufsize <number>
741 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
742 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
743 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
744 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
745 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
746 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
747 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
748 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400749 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
750 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
751 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200752
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200753tune.chksize <number>
754 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
755 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
756 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
757 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
758 checks whenever possible.
759
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100760tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
761 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
762 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
763 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
764 this value. The default value is 1.
765
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200766tune.http.maxhdr <number>
767 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
768 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
769 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
770 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
771 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
772 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
773 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
774 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
775 limit too high.
776
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100777tune.maxaccept <number>
778 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
779 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
780 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100781 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100782 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
783 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100784 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100785 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
786
787tune.maxpollevents <number>
788 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
789 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
790 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
791 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
792 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
793
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200794tune.maxrewrite <number>
795 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
796 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
797 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
798 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
799 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
800 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
801 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
802 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
803 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
804 bufsize.
805
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200806tune.pipesize <number>
807 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
808 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
809 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
810 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
811 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
812 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
813
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100814tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
815tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
816 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
817 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
818 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
819 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
820 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
821 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
822 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
823
824tune.sndbuf.client <number>
825tune.sndbuf.server <number>
826 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
827 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
828 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
829 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
830 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
831 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
832 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
833 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
834 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
835 notifying haproxy again.
836
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100837tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
838 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
839 defines how much memory should be allocated for the intenal compression
840 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
841 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
842 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
843
844tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
845 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
846 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
847 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
848 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008503.3. Debugging
851--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200852
853debug
854 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
855 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
856 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
857 system startup.
858
859quiet
860 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
861 line argument "-q".
862
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200863
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008643.4. Userlists
865--------------
866It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
867http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
868it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
869
870userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100871 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100872 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
873
874group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100875 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100876 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
877 proceeded by "users" keyword.
878
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100879user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
880 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100881 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
882 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100883 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
884 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100885 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
886 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
887
888
889 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100890 userlist L1
891 group G1 users tiger,scott
892 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100893
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100894 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
895 user scott insecure-password elgato
896 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100897
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100898 userlist L2
899 group G1
900 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100901
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100902 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
903 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
904 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100905
906 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200907
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200908
9093.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200910----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200911It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
912haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
913pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
914identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
915or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
916Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
917known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
918the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
919process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
920during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
921tables.
922
923peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -0400924 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200925 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
926
927peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
928 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
929 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
930 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
931 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
932 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
933 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
934
935 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
936 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
937
938 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
939 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
940 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
941 across all peers.
942
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200943 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200944 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100945 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
946 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
947 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200948
949 backend mybackend
950 mode tcp
951 balance roundrobin
952 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
953 stick on src
954
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100955 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
956 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200957
958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009594. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200960----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100961
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200962Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
963 - defaults <name>
964 - frontend <name>
965 - backend <name>
966 - listen <name>
967
968A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
969its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
970section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100971section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972
973A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
974connections.
975
976A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
977to forward incoming connections.
978
979A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
980parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
981
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100982All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
983'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
984case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
985
986Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
987logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
988proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
989However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
990name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
991
992Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
993and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100994bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100995protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
996modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
997arbitrary criteria.
998
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010004.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1001--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001003The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1004limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1005they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1006limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001007marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001008option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001009and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1010with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1011specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001012
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001013
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001014 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1015------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1016acl - X X X
1017appsession - - X X
1018backlog X X X -
1019balance X - X X
1020bind - X X -
1021bind-process X X X X
1022block - X X X
1023capture cookie - X X -
1024capture request header - X X -
1025capture response header - X X -
1026clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001027compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001028contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1029cookie X - X X
1030default-server X - X X
1031default_backend X X X -
1032description - X X X
1033disabled X X X X
1034dispatch - - X X
1035enabled X X X X
1036errorfile X X X X
1037errorloc X X X X
1038errorloc302 X X X X
1039-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1040errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001041force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001042fullconn X - X X
1043grace X X X X
1044hash-type X - X X
1045http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001046http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001047http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001048http-request - X X X
1049id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001050ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001051log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001052maxconn X X X -
1053mode X X X X
1054monitor fail - X X -
1055monitor-net X X X -
1056monitor-uri X X X -
1057option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1058option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1059option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1060option allbackups (*) X - X X
1061option checkcache (*) X - X X
1062option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1063option contstats (*) X X X -
1064option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1065option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1066option forceclose (*) X X X X
1067-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1068option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001069option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001070option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001071option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1072option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1073option httpchk X - X X
1074option httpclose (*) X X X X
1075option httplog X X X X
1076option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001077option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001078option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001079option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1080option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1081option logasap (*) X X X -
1082option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001083option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001084option nolinger (*) X X X X
1085option originalto X X X X
1086option persist (*) X - X X
1087option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001088option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001089option smtpchk X - X X
1090option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1091option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1092option splice-request (*) X X X X
1093option splice-response (*) X X X X
1094option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1095option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1096-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1097option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1098option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1099option tcpka X X X X
1100option tcplog X X X X
1101option transparent (*) X - X X
1102persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1103rate-limit sessions X X X -
1104redirect - X X X
1105redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1106redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1107reqadd - X X X
1108reqallow - X X X
1109reqdel - X X X
1110reqdeny - X X X
1111reqiallow - X X X
1112reqidel - X X X
1113reqideny - X X X
1114reqipass - X X X
1115reqirep - X X X
1116reqisetbe - X X X
1117reqitarpit - X X X
1118reqpass - X X X
1119reqrep - X X X
1120-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1121reqsetbe - X X X
1122reqtarpit - X X X
1123retries X - X X
1124rspadd - X X X
1125rspdel - X X X
1126rspdeny - X X X
1127rspidel - X X X
1128rspideny - X X X
1129rspirep - X X X
1130rsprep - X X X
1131server - - X X
1132source X - X X
1133srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001134stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001135stats auth X - X X
1136stats enable X - X X
1137stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001138stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001139stats realm X - X X
1140stats refresh X - X X
1141stats scope X - X X
1142stats show-desc X - X X
1143stats show-legends X - X X
1144stats show-node X - X X
1145stats uri X - X X
1146-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1147stick match - - X X
1148stick on - - X X
1149stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001150stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001151stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001152tcp-request connection - X X -
1153tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001154tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001155tcp-response content - - X X
1156tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001157timeout check X - X X
1158timeout client X X X -
1159timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1160timeout connect X - X X
1161timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1162timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1163timeout http-request X X X X
1164timeout queue X - X X
1165timeout server X - X X
1166timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1167timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001168timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001169transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001170unique-id-format X X X -
1171unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001172use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001173use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001174------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1175 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001176
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011784.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1179---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001180
1181This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1182
1183
1184acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1185 Declare or complete an access list.
1186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1187 no | yes | yes | yes
1188 Example:
1189 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1190 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1191 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001193 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001194
1195
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001196appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1197 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001198 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1200 no | no | yes | yes
1201 Arguments :
1202 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1203 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1204
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001205 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001206 checked in each cookie value.
1207
1208 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1209 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1210 milliseconds.
1211
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001212 request-learn
1213 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1214 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1215 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1216 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1217 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1218 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1219
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001220 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1221 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1222 data following this prefix.
1223
1224 Example :
1225 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1226
1227 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1228 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1229
1230 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1231 2 modes are currently supported :
1232 - path-parameters :
1233 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1234 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1235 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1236 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1237 - query-string :
1238 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1239 query string.
1240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001241 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1242 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1243 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1244 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001245 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1246 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1247 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001248 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1249 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1250
1251 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1252
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001253 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1254 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1255 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1256
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001257 Example :
1258 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1259
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001260 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1261 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001262
1263
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001264backlog <conns>
1265 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1267 yes | yes | yes | no
1268 Arguments :
1269 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1270 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001271 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001272
1273 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1274 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1275 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1276 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1277 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1278 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1279 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1280 backlog parameter.
1281
1282 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1283 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1284 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1285
1286 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1287
1288
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001289balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001290balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001291 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1293 yes | no | yes | yes
1294 Arguments :
1295 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1296 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1297 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1298 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1299
1300 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1301 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1302 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1303 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001304 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1305 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1306 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1307 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1308 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1309 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1310 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1311 it, so that you don't worry.
1312
1313 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1314 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1315 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1316 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1317 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1318 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1319 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1320 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001321
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001322 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1323 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1324 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1325 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1326 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1327 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1328 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1329 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1330
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001331 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1332 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1333 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1334 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001335 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001336 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1337 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1338 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1339 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1340 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001341 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1342 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1343 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1344 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1345 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1346 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001348 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1349 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1350 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1351 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1352 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1353 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1354 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1355 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001356 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001357 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001358 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1359 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1360 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001361
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001362 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1363 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1364 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1365 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1366 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1367 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1368 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1369 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1370 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1371 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1372 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1373 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001374
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001375 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001376 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1377 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1378 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1379 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1380 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1381 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1382 URIs start with a leading "/".
1383
1384 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1385 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1386 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1387 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1388
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001389 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001390 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1391
1392 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001393 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1394 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1395 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1396 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1397 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1398 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1399 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1400 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1401 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1402 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1403 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1404 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1405 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1406 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1407 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1408 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1409 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1410 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1411 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001412
1413 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1414 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1415 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1416 server will receive the request.
1417
1418 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1419 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1420 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1421 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1422 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001423 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1424 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1425 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001426
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001427 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1428 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1429 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1430 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1431 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001432
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001433 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001434 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1435 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1436 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1437
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001438 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1439 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1440 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1441
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001442 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001443 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001444 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1445 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1446 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1447 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1448 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1449 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001450 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001451 used instead.
1452
1453 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1454 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1455 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1456 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1457
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001458 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1459 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1460 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1461
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001462 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001463
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001464 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001465 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1466 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001467
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001468 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001469 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001470
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001471 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1472 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1473 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001474
1475 Examples :
1476 balance roundrobin
1477 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001478 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001479 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1480 balance hdr(host)
1481 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001482
1483 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1484 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001486 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001487 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1488 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1489 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1490 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1491
1492 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1493 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1494 defaults to 16 kB.
1495
1496 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1497 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1498
1499 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1500 Round Robin.
1501
1502 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1503 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1504 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1505 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1506
1507 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1508
1509 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001510 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001511 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1512 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1513 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001514
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001515 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1516 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001517
1518
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001519bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1520bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001521 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1523 no | yes | yes | no
1524 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001525 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1526 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1527 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1528 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001529 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001530
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001531 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1532 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001533 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1534 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1535 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001536 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1537 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1538 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1539 the range.
1540
1541 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1542 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1543 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1544 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1545 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1546 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1547 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001548 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001549 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001550
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001551 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1552 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1553 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1554 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1555 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1556 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1557 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1558 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1559
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001560 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1561 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1562 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1563 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001565 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1566 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1567 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1568 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1569 in a frontend.
1570
1571 Example :
1572 listen http_proxy
1573 bind :80,:443
1574 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001575 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001576
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001577 listen http_https_proxy
1578 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001579 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001580
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001581 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001582 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001583
1584
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001585bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001586 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1588 yes | yes | yes | yes
1589 Arguments :
1590 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1591 may be used to override a default value.
1592
1593 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1594 option may be combined with other numbers.
1595
1596 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1597 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1598 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1599 missing from all processes.
1600
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001601 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1602 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1603 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1604 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1605 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001606
1607 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1608 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1609 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1610 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1611 and 'even' instances.
1612
1613 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1614 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1615 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1616 32.
1617
1618 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1619 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1620
1621 Example :
1622 listen app_ip1
1623 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001624 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001625
1626 listen app_ip2
1627 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001628 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001629
1630 listen management
1631 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001632 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001633
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001634 listen management
1635 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1636 bind-process 1-4
1637
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001638 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1639
1640
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001641block { if | unless } <condition>
1642 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1644 no | yes | yes | yes
1645
1646 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1647 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001648 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001649 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001650 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1651 "block" statements per instance.
1652
1653 Example:
1654 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1655 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1656 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1657 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001659 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001660
1661
1662capture cookie <name> len <length>
1663 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1665 no | yes | yes | no
1666 Arguments :
1667 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1668 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1669 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1670 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1671 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1672
1673 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1674 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1675 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1676 right if it exceeds <length>.
1677
1678 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1679 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1680 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1681 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1682
1683 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1684 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1685 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1686
1687 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1688 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1689 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1690 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001691 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001692 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1693
1694 Example:
1695 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1696
1697 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001698 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001699
1700
1701capture request header <name> len <length>
1702 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1704 no | yes | yes | no
1705 Arguments :
1706 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001707 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001708 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1709 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1710 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1711
1712 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1713 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1714 it exceeds <length>.
1715
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001716 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001717 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1718 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001719 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1720 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1721 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1722 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001723 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001724 environments to find where the request came from.
1725
1726 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1727 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1728 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1729 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001730
1731 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1732 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1733 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1734 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1735
1736 Example:
1737 capture request header Host len 15
1738 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1739 capture request header Referrer len 15
1740
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001741 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001742 about logging.
1743
1744
1745capture response header <name> len <length>
1746 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1748 no | yes | yes | no
1749 Arguments :
1750 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001751 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001752 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1753 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1754 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1755
1756 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1757 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1758 it exceeds <length>.
1759
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001760 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001761 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1762 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1763 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001764 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1765 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1766 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1767 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001768
1769 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1770 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1771 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1772 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1773
1774 Example:
1775 capture response header Content-length len 9
1776 capture response header Location len 15
1777
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001778 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001779 about logging.
1780
1781
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001782clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1785 yes | yes | yes | no
1786 Arguments :
1787 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1788 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1789 as explained at the top of this document.
1790
1791 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1792 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1793 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1794 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1795 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1796 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1797 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1798 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001799 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001800 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1801 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1802
1803 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1804 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1805 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1806 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1807 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1808 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1809
1810 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1811 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1812
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001813 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1814 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001815
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001816compression algo <algorithm> ...
1817compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001818compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001819 Enable HTTP compression.
1820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1821 yes | yes | yes | yes
1822 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01001823 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
1824 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
1825 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
1826
1827 The currently supported algorithms are :
1828 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developping
1829 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
1830 data.
1831
1832 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
1833 support for zlib was built in.
1834
1835 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
1836 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
1837 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
1838 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
1839 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
1840 in.
1841
1842 Compression will be activated depending of the Accept-Encoding request
1843 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02001844
1845 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
1846 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
1847 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
1848 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
1849 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
1850 and need to prevent it from emitting invalid payloads. In this case, simply
1851 removing the header in the configuration does not work because it applies
1852 before the header is parsed, so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The
1853 "offload" setting should then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001854
1855 Examples :
1856 compression algo gzip
1857 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001858
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001859contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001860 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1862 yes | no | yes | yes
1863 Arguments :
1864 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1865 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1866 as explained at the top of this document.
1867
1868 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001869 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001870 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001871 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1872 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1873 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1874 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1875
1876 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1877 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1878 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1879 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1880 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1881 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1882
1883 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1884 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1885 instead.
1886
1887 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1888 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1889
1890
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001891cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001892 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
1893 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001894 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1896 yes | no | yes | yes
1897 Arguments :
1898 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1899 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1900 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1901 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1902 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1903 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1904 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1905 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1906 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1907
1908 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1909 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1910 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1911 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1912 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1913 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1914 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1915 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1916 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1917 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1918 "insert" and "prefix".
1919
1920 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001921 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001922
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001923 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001924 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1925 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1926 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1927 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1928 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1929 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1930 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1931 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1932 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1933 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001934
1935 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1936 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1937 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1938 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1939 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1940 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1941 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1942 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1943 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1944 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001945 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1946 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1947 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001948
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001949 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1950 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1951 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001952 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1953 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1954 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1955 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001956 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1957 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1958 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959
1960 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1961 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1962 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1963 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1964 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1965 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1966 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1967 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1968 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1969
1970 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1971 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1972 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1973 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1974 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1975 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1976 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1977 persistence cookie in the cache.
1978 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1979
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001980 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1981 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1982 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1983 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1984 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1985 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1986 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1987 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1988 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1989 they logout.
1990
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02001991 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
1992 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
1993 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
1994 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
1995
1996 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
1997 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
1998 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
1999 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2000 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2001 this attribute.
2002
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002003 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002004 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002005 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2006 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2007 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2008 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2009 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2010 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002011
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002012 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2013 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2014 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2015 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2016 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2017 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2018 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2019 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2020 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2021 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2022 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2023 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2024 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2025 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2026 the site.
2027
2028 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2029 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2030 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2031 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2032 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2033 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2034 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2035 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2036 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2037 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2038 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2039 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2040 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2041 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2042 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2043 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2046 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2047 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2048 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002049
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002050 Examples :
2051 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2052 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2053 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002054 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002055
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002056 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002057 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002058
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002059
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002060default-server [param*]
2061 Change default options for a server in a backend
2062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2063 yes | no | yes | yes
2064 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002065 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2066 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2067 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2068 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002069
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002070 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002071 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2072
2073 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002075
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002076default_backend <backend>
2077 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2079 yes | yes | yes | no
2080 Arguments :
2081 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2082
2083 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2084 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2085 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2086 will catch all undetermined requests.
2087
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002088 Example :
2089
2090 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2091 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2092 default_backend dynamic
2093
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002094 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2095
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002096
2097disabled
2098 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2100 yes | yes | yes | yes
2101 Arguments : none
2102
2103 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2104 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2105 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2106 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2107 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2108 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2109 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2110
2111 See also : "enabled"
2112
2113
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002114dispatch <address>:<port>
2115 Set a default server address
2116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2117 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002118 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002119
2120 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2121 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2122 during start-up.
2123
2124 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2125 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2126 possible with normal servers.
2127
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002128 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002129 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2130 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2131 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2132 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2133
2134 See also : "server"
2135
2136
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002137enabled
2138 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2140 yes | yes | yes | yes
2141 Arguments : none
2142
2143 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2144 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2145
2146 See also : "disabled"
2147
2148
2149errorfile <code> <file>
2150 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2152 yes | yes | yes | yes
2153 Arguments :
2154 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002155 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002156
2157 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002158 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002159 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002160 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2161 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002162
2163 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2164 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2165 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2166
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002167 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2170 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2171 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2172 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2173
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002174 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2175 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2176 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2177 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2178 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2179 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2180
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002181 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2182 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2183 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002184 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002185 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2186
2187 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2188
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002189 Example :
2190 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2191 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2192 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2193
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002194
2195errorloc <code> <url>
2196errorloc302 <code> <url>
2197 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2199 yes | yes | yes | yes
2200 Arguments :
2201 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002202 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002203
2204 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2205 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2206 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2207 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2208 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2209
2210 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2211 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2212 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2213
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002214 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2215
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002216 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2217 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2218 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2219 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2220 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2221 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2222 request.
2223
2224 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2225
2226
2227errorloc303 <code> <url>
2228 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2230 yes | yes | yes | yes
2231 Arguments :
2232 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2233 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2234
2235 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2236 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2237 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2238 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2239 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2240
2241 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2242 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2243 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2244
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002245 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2246
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002247 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2248 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2249 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2250 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002251 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002252
2253 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2254
2255
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002256force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2257 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2258 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2259 no | yes | yes | yes
2260
2261 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2262 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2263 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2264 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2265 marked down for maintenance operations.
2266
2267 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2268 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2269 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2270 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2271 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2272 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2273 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2274 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2275 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2276
2277 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2278 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2279 is used.
2280
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002281 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002282 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002283
2284
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002285fullconn <conns>
2286 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2288 yes | no | yes | yes
2289 Arguments :
2290 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2291 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2292
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002293 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002294 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002295 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002296 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2297 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2298 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2299 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2300 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002301 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002302
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002303 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2304 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2305 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2306
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002307 Example :
2308 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2309 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2310 # connections.
2311 backend dynamic
2312 fullconn 10000
2313 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2314 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2315
2316 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2317
2318
2319grace <time>
2320 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002322 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002323 Arguments :
2324 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2325 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2326 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2327
2328 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2329 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002330 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002331 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2332
2333 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2334 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2335 simplify it.
2336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002337
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002338hash-type <method>
2339 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2341 yes | no | yes | yes
2342 Arguments :
2343 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2344 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2345 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2346 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2347 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2348 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2349 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2350 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2351 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2352
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002353 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2354 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2355 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2356 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2357 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2358 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2359 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2360 this value.
2361
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002362 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2363 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2364 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2365 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2366 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2367 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2368 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2369 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2370 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2371 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2372 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2373 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2374 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2375
2376 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2377
2378 See also : "balance", "server"
2379
2380
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381http-check disable-on-404
2382 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002384 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385 Arguments : none
2386
2387 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2388 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2389 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2390 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2391 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2392 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2393 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2394 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002395 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2396 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2397 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2398
2399 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2400
2401
2402http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002403 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002405 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002406 Arguments :
2407 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2408 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002409 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002410 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2411 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2412 details on the supported keywords.
2413
2414 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2415 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2416 with the usual backslash ('\').
2417
2418 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2419 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2420 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2421 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2422 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2423
2424 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002425 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002426 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2427 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2428 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2429
2430 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002431 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002432 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2433 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2434 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2435 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2436
2437 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002438 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002439 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2440 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2441 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2442 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2443 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2444 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2445 trace).
2446
2447 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002448 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002449 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2450 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2451 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2452 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2453 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2454 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2455
2456 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2457 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2458 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2459 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2460 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2461 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2462 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2463 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2464
2465 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2466 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2467
2468 Examples :
2469 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002470 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002471
2472 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002473 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002474
2475 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002476 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002477
2478 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002479 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002481 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002482
2483
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002484http-check send-state
2485 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2487 yes | no | yes | yes
2488 Arguments : none
2489
2490 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2491 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2492 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2493 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2494 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2495
2496 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2497 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2498 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2499 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2500 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2501 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2502 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2503 checked in multiple backends.
2504
2505 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2506 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2507
2508 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2509 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2510 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2511 one fails.
2512
2513 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2514 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2515 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2516
2517 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2518 server's queue.
2519
2520 Example of a header received by the application server :
2521 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2522 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2523
2524 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2525
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002526http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002527 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002528 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2529
2530 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2531 no | yes | yes | yes
2532
2533 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2534 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2535 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002536 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2537 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002538 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2539
2540 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2541 instance.
2542
2543 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002544 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2545 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2546 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002547
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002548 http-request allow if nagios
2549 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2550 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2551 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002552
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002553 Example:
2554 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002555
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002556 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002557
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002558 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2559 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002560
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002561http-send-name-header [<header>]
2562 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2563
2564 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2565 yes | no | yes | yes
2566
2567 Arguments :
2568
2569 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2570
2571 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2572 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2573 is added with the header string proved.
2574
2575 See also : "server"
2576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002577id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002578 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2580 no | yes | yes | yes
2581 Arguments : none
2582
2583 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2584 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2585 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002586
2587
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002588ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2589 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2590 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2591 no | yes | yes | yes
2592
2593 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2594 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2595 and running).
2596
2597 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2598 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2599 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2600 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2601 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2602
2603 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2604 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2605
2606 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2607 "unless" condition is met.
2608
2609 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2610
2611
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002612log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002613log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002614no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002615 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2617 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002618
2619 Prefix :
2620 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2621 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2622 prefix does not allow arguments.
2623
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002624 Arguments :
2625 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2626 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2627 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2628 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2629 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2630 parameter.
2631
2632 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2633 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2634
2635 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2636 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2637 standard syslog port).
2638
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002639 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2640 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2641 standard syslog port).
2642
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002643 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2644 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2645 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2646 appropriately writeable).
2647
2648 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2649
2650 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2651 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2652 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2653
2654 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2655 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2656 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002657 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2658 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2659 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2660 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2661 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002662
2663 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2664
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002665 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2666 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2667 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002668
2669 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2670 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2671 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2672 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2673
2674 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2675 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002676
2677 Example :
2678 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002679 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2680 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002681
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002682log-format <string>
2683 Allows you to custom a log line.
2684
2685 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2686
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002687
2688maxconn <conns>
2689 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2691 yes | yes | yes | no
2692 Arguments :
2693 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2694 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2695 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2696 closes.
2697
2698 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2699 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2700 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2701 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2702 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2703 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2704 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2705 properly tuned.
2706
2707 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2708 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2709 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2710
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02002711 By default, this value is set to 2000.
2712
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002713 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2714
2715
2716mode { tcp|http|health }
2717 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2719 yes | yes | yes | yes
2720 Arguments :
2721 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2722 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2723 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2724 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2725
2726 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2727 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2728 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2729 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2730 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2731
2732 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002733 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
2734 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
2735 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
2736 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
2737 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
2738 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
2739 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002740
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002741 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2742 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2743 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002744
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002745 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002746 defaults http_instances
2747 mode http
2748
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002749 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002750
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002752monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002753 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2755 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002756 Arguments :
2757 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2758 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002759 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002760 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2761 backend and its backup.
2762
2763 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2764 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2765 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2766 servers in a list of backends.
2767
2768 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2769 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2770 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2771 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2772 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2773 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2774 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002775 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2776 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002777
2778 Example:
2779 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002780 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002781 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2782 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2783 monitor-uri /site_alive
2784 monitor fail if site_dead
2785
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002786 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002787
2788
2789monitor-net <source>
2790 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2792 yes | yes | yes | no
2793 Arguments :
2794 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2795 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2796 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2797 followed by a mask.
2798
2799 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2800 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002801 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002802 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2803
2804 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2805 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2806 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2807 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002808 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
2809 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
2810 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002811
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02002812 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
2813 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
2814 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
2815 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
2816 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
2817 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002818
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002819 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2820 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002821
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002822 Example :
2823 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2824 frontend www
2825 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2826
2827 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2828
2829
2830monitor-uri <uri>
2831 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2833 yes | yes | yes | no
2834 Arguments :
2835 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2836 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2837
2838 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2839 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2840 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2841 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2842 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2843 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2844 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2845 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2846
2847 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2848 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2849 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2850 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2851 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2852 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2853
2854 Example :
2855 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2856 frontend www
2857 mode http
2858 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2859
2860 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2861
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002862
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002863option abortonclose
2864no option abortonclose
2865 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2867 yes | no | yes | yes
2868 Arguments : none
2869
2870 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2871 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2872 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2873 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002874 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002875 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2876 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2877 encountered while delivering the response.
2878
2879 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2880 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2881 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2882 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2883 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2884 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002885 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002886 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002887 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002888 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2889 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2890 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2891
2892 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2893 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2894 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2895 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2896 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2897 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2898 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2899 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002900 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002901
2902 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2903 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2904
2905 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2906
2907
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002908option accept-invalid-http-request
2909no option accept-invalid-http-request
2910 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2912 yes | yes | yes | no
2913 Arguments : none
2914
2915 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2916 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2917 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2918 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2919 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2920 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2921 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2922 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002923 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2924 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2925 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2926 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2927 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2928 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002929
2930 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2931 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2932 been confirmed.
2933
2934 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2935 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002936 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2937 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002938 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2939
2940 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2941 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2942
2943 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2944 stats socket.
2945
2946
2947option accept-invalid-http-response
2948no option accept-invalid-http-response
2949 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2951 yes | no | yes | yes
2952 Arguments : none
2953
2954 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2955 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2956 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2957 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2958 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2959 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2960 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2961 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2962 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2963
2964 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2965 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2966 been confirmed.
2967
2968 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2969 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2970 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2971 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2972
2973 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2974 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2975
2976 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2977 stats socket.
2978
2979
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002980option allbackups
2981no option allbackups
2982 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2984 yes | no | yes | yes
2985 Arguments : none
2986
2987 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2988 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2989 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2990 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2991 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2992 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2993 order between the backup servers anymore.
2994
2995 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2996 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2997
2998 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2999 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3000
3001
3002option checkcache
3003no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003004 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3006 yes | no | yes | yes
3007 Arguments : none
3008
3009 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3010 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003011 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003012 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3013 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003014 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003015
3016 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003017 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003018 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003019 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3020 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003021 to the client are :
3022 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003023 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003024 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003025 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3026 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3027 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3028 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3029 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3030 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3031 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3032 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3033 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3034 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3035 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3036
3037 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003038 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003039 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003040 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003041 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3042
3043 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3044 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003045 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003046 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3047
3048 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3049 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3050
3051
3052option clitcpka
3053no option clitcpka
3054 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 yes | yes | yes | no
3057 Arguments : none
3058
3059 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3060 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3061 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3062 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3063
3064 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3065 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3066 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3067 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3068
3069 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3070 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3071 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3072 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3073 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3074
3075 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3076
3077 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3078 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3079 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3080
3081 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3082 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3083
3084 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3085
3086
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003087option contstats
3088 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3090 yes | yes | yes | no
3091 Arguments : none
3092
3093 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3094 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3095 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3096 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3097 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3098 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3099 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3100
3101
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003102option dontlog-normal
3103no option dontlog-normal
3104 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3106 yes | yes | yes | no
3107 Arguments : none
3108
3109 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3110 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3111 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3112 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3113 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3114 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3115 logged.
3116
3117 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3118 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3119 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003121 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003122 logging.
3123
3124
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003125option dontlognull
3126no option dontlognull
3127 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3129 yes | yes | yes | no
3130 Arguments : none
3131
3132 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3133 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3134 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3135 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3136 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3137 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3138 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3139
3140 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3141 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3142 would not be logged.
3143
3144 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3145 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3146
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003147 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003148
3149
3150option forceclose
3151no option forceclose
3152 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003154 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003155 Arguments : none
3156
3157 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3158 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3159 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3160 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3161 global session times in the logs.
3162
3163 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003164 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003165 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3166 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3167 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3168 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003169
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003170 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3171 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3172 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3173
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003174 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3175 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3176
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003177 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003178
3179
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003180option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003181 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3183 yes | yes | yes | yes
3184 Arguments :
3185 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3186 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003187 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003188 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003189
3190 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3191 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3192 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3193 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3194 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3195 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3196 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003197 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3198 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3199 possible that the client has already brought one.
3200
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003201 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003202 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003203 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3204 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003205 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3206 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003207
3208 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3209 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3210 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3211 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3212 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3213 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3214 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3215
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003216 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3217 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3218 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3219 are under the control of the end-user.
3220
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003221 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003222 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3223 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003224 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3225 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3226 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003227
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003228 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3229 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3230 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3231 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3232 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003233
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003234 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003235 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3236 frontend www
3237 mode http
3238 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3239
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003240 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3241 backend www
3242 mode http
3243 option forwardfor header X-Client
3244
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003245 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3246 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003247
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003248
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003249option http-no-delay
3250no option http-no-delay
3251 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3253 yes | yes | yes | yes
3254 Arguments : none
3255
3256 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3257 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3258 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3259 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3260 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3261 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3262 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3263 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3264 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3265 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3266 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3267 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3268 affected.
3269
3270 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3271 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3272 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3273 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3274 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3275 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3276 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3277 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3278 latency environments.
3279
3280
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003281option http-pretend-keepalive
3282no option http-pretend-keepalive
3283 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3285 yes | yes | yes | yes
3286 Arguments : none
3287
3288 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3289 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3290 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3291 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3292 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3293 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3294 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3295 consider the response complete.
3296
3297 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3298 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3299 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3300 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3301 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3302 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3303
3304 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3305 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3306 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3307 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3308 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3309 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3310 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3311
3312 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3313 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003314 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003315 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3316 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003317
3318 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3319 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3320
3321 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3322
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003323
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003324option http-server-close
3325no option http-server-close
3326 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3328 yes | yes | yes | yes
3329 Arguments : none
3330
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003331 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3332 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3333 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3334 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3335 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3336 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3337 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3338 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3339 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3340 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3341 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3342 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003343
3344 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3345 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3346 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3347 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003348 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3349 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003350
3351 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3352 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003353 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3354 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3355 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003356
3357 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3358 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3359
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003360 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3361 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003362
3363
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003364option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003365no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003366 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3368 yes | yes | yes | no
3369 Arguments : none
3370
3371 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3372 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3373 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3374 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3375 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3376 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3377 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3378
3379 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3380 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3381 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3382 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3383 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3384 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3385 request along its whole life.
3386
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003387 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3388 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3389 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3390 front of an existing proxy.
3391
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003392 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3393
3394 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3395 http-server-close".
3396
3397
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003398option httpchk
3399option httpchk <uri>
3400option httpchk <method> <uri>
3401option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3402 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3404 yes | no | yes | yes
3405 Arguments :
3406 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3407 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3408 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3409 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3410 ones.
3411
3412 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3413 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3414 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3415
3416 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3417 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3418 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3419 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3420 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3421
3422 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3423 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3424 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3425 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3426 the lack of any response.
3427
3428 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3429
3430 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3431 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3432 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3433
3434 Examples :
3435 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3436 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3437 backend https_relay
3438 mode tcp
3439 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3440 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3441
3442 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003443 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3444 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003445
3446
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003447option httpclose
3448no option httpclose
3449 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3451 yes | yes | yes | yes
3452 Arguments : none
3453
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003454 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3455 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3456 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3457 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3458 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3459 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3460 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003461
3462 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003463 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003464 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3465 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3466 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3467 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3468 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003469
3470 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3471 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3472 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003473 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3474 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003475
3476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3478
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003479 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3480 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003481
3482
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003483option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003484 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3486 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003487 Arguments :
3488 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3489 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3490 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3491 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3492 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003493
3494 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3495 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3496 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3497 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3498 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3499 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3500 ports.
3501
3502 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3503
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003504 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3505 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3506 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3507 by default.
3508
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003509 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003510
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003511
3512option http_proxy
3513no option http_proxy
3514 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3516 yes | yes | yes | yes
3517 Arguments : none
3518
3519 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3520 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3521 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3522 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3523 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3524
3525 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3526 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3527 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3528 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003529 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003530 be analyzed.
3531
3532 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3533 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3534
3535 Example :
3536 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3537 backend direct_forward
3538 option httpclose
3539 option http_proxy
3540
3541 See also : "option httpclose"
3542
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003543
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003544option independent-streams
3545no option independent-streams
3546 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3548 yes | yes | yes | yes
3549 Arguments : none
3550
3551 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3552 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3553 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3554 receive data or not.
3555
3556 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3557 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3558 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3559 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3560 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3561 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3562 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3563 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3564 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3565 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3566 socket buffers.
3567
3568 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3569 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3570 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3571 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3572 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3573
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003574 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
3575 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
3576 deprecated.
3577
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003578 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003579
3580
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003581option ldap-check
3582 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3584 yes | no | yes | yes
3585 Arguments : none
3586
3587 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3588 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3589 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3590 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3591
3592 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3593 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3594
3595 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3596 configure it.
3597
3598 Example :
3599 option ldap-check
3600
3601 See also : "option httpchk"
3602
3603
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003604option log-health-checks
3605no option log-health-checks
3606 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3608 yes | no | yes | yes
3609 Arguments : none
3610
3611 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3612 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3613 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3614 of additional information is limited.
3615
3616 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3617 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3618
3619 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3620
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003621
3622option log-separate-errors
3623no option log-separate-errors
3624 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3626 yes | yes | yes | no
3627 Arguments : none
3628
3629 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3630 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3631 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3632 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3633 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3634 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3635 provides very important information.
3636
3637 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3638 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3639 error logs.
3640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003641 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003642 logging.
3643
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003644
3645option logasap
3646no option logasap
3647 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3649 yes | yes | yes | no
3650 Arguments : none
3651
3652 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3653 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3654 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3655 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3656 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3657 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3658 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003659 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003660 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3661 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3662
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003663 Examples :
3664 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3665 mode http
3666 option httplog
3667 option logasap
3668 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3669
3670 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3671 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3672 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3673 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003675 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003676 logging.
3677
3678
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003679option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3680 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3682 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003683 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003684 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3685 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003686
3687 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3688 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3689 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3690 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3691 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3692 in the MySQL table, like this :
3693
3694 USE mysql;
3695 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3696 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3697
3698 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3699 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3700 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3701 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3702 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3703 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3704 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3705 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3706 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3707
3708 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3709 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003710
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003711 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003712
3713 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3714 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3715 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3716 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3717 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3718 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3719
3720 See also: "option httpchk"
3721
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003722option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3723 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3725 yes | no | yes | yes
3726 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003727 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3728 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003729
3730 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3731 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3732 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3733 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3734
3735 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003736
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003737option nolinger
3738no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003739 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003740 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3741 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003742 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003743
3744 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3745 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3746 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3747 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3748 connections.
3749
3750 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3751 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3752 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3753 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3754 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3755 this too.
3756
3757 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3758 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3759 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3760
3761 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3762 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3763 for servers.
3764
3765 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3766 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3767
3768
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003769option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3770 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3772 yes | yes | yes | yes
3773 Arguments :
3774 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3775 matching <network>
3776 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3777 header name.
3778
3779 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3780 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3781 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3782 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3783 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3784 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3785 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3786 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3787 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3788 possible that the client has already brought one.
3789
3790 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3791 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3792 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3793 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3794 header and requires different one.
3795
3796 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3797 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3798 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3799 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3800 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3801 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3802 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3803
3804 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3805 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3806 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3807 both are defined.
3808
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003809 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3810 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3811 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3812 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3813 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003814
3815 Examples :
3816 # Original Destination address
3817 frontend www
3818 mode http
3819 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3820
3821 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3822 backend www
3823 mode http
3824 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3825
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003826 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3827 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003828
3829
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003830option persist
3831no option persist
3832 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3833 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3834 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003835 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003836
3837 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3838 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3839 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3840 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3841 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3842 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3843 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3844 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3845 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3846 redirected to another valid server.
3847
3848 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3849 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3850
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003851 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003852
3853
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003854option redispatch
3855no option redispatch
3856 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3857 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3858 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003859 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003860
3861 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3862 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3863 be able to access the service anymore.
3864
3865 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3866 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3867
3868 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3869 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3870 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003871
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003872 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3873 "redisp" keywords.
3874
3875 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3876 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3877
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003878 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003879
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003880
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003881option redis-check
3882 Use redis health checks for server testing
3883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3884 yes | no | yes | yes
3885 Arguments : none
3886
3887 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3888 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3889 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3890 find the "+PONG" response message.
3891
3892 Example :
3893 option redis-check
3894
3895 See also : "option httpchk"
3896
3897
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003898option smtpchk
3899option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3900 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3902 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003903 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003904 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3905 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3906 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3907
3908 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3909 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3910 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3911
3912 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3913 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3914 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3915 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3916 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3917 dead server.
3918
3919 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3920 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3921 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3922 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3923
3924 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3925 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3926 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3927 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3928 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3929
3930 Example :
3931 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3932
3933 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3934
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003936option socket-stats
3937no option socket-stats
3938
3939 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3941 yes | yes | yes | no
3942
3943 Arguments : none
3944
3945
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003946option splice-auto
3947no option splice-auto
3948 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3950 yes | yes | yes | yes
3951 Arguments : none
3952
3953 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3954 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3955 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3956 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003957 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003958 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3959 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3960 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3961 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3962
3963 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3964 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3965 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3966 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3967 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3968 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3969 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3970 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3971 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3972 keyword.
3973
3974 Example :
3975 option splice-auto
3976
3977 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3978 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3979
3980 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3981 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3982
3983
3984option splice-request
3985no option splice-request
3986 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3988 yes | yes | yes | yes
3989 Arguments : none
3990
3991 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003992 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003993 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3994 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3995 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3996 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3997
3998 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3999
4000 Example :
4001 option splice-request
4002
4003 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4004 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4005
4006 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4007 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4008
4009
4010option splice-response
4011no option splice-response
4012 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4014 yes | yes | yes | yes
4015 Arguments : none
4016
4017 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004018 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004019 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4020 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4021 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4022 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4023
4024 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4025
4026 Example :
4027 option splice-response
4028
4029 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4030 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4031
4032 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4033 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4034
4035
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004036option srvtcpka
4037no option srvtcpka
4038 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4040 yes | no | yes | yes
4041 Arguments : none
4042
4043 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4044 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4045 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4046 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4047
4048 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4049 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4050 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4051 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4052
4053 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4054 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4055 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4056 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4057 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4058
4059 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4060
4061 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4062 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4063 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4064
4065 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4066 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4067
4068 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4069
4070
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004071option ssl-hello-chk
4072 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4074 yes | no | yes | yes
4075 Arguments : none
4076
4077 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4078 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4079 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4080 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4081 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4082 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4083 hello message.
4084
4085 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4086 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4087 messages, which is appreciable.
4088
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004089 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4090 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4091 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004092
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004093 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4094
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004095
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004096option tcp-smart-accept
4097no option tcp-smart-accept
4098 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4100 yes | yes | yes | no
4101 Arguments : none
4102
4103 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4104 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4105 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4106 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4107 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4108 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4109
4110 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4111 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4112 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4113 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4114
4115 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4116 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4117 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4118 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4119
4120 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4121 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4122 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4123
4124 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4125 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4126 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4127
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004128 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4129
4130
4131option tcp-smart-connect
4132no option tcp-smart-connect
4133 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4135 yes | no | yes | yes
4136 Arguments : none
4137
4138 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4139 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4140 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4141 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4142 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4143
4144 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4145 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4146 complex.
4147
4148 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4149 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4150 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4151
4152 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4153 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4154
4155 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4156
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004157
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004158option tcpka
4159 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4161 yes | yes | yes | yes
4162 Arguments : none
4163
4164 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4165 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4166 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4167 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4168
4169 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4170 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4171 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4172 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4173
4174 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4175 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4176 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4177 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4178 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4179
4180 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4181
4182 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4183 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4184 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4185 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4186 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4187 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4188 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4189 backends.
4190
4191 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4192
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004193
4194option tcplog
4195 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4197 yes | yes | yes | yes
4198 Arguments : none
4199
4200 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4201 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4202 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4203 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4204 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4205 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4206 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4207 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4208
4209 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004211 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004212
4213
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004214option transparent
4215no option transparent
4216 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004218 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004219 Arguments : none
4220
4221 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4222 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4223 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4224 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4225 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4226 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4227 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4228 appropriate server.
4229
4230 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4231 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4232
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004233 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004234 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004235
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004236
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004237persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004238persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004239 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4241 yes | no | yes | yes
4242 Arguments :
4243 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004244 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4245 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004246
4247 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4248 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4249 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4250 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4251 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4252 forwarded to this server.
4253
4254 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4255 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4256 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004257 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004258 a single "listen" section.
4259
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004260 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4261 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4262 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4263
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004264 Example :
4265 listen tse-farm
4266 bind :3389
4267 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4268 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4269 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4270 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4271 persist rdp-cookie
4272 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004273 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004274 balance rdp-cookie
4275 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4276 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4277
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004278 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4279 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004280
4281
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004282rate-limit sessions <rate>
4283 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4285 yes | yes | yes | no
4286 Arguments :
4287 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4288 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4289
4290 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4291 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4292 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4293 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4294 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4295 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4296
4297 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4298 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4299 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4300 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4301
4302 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4303 listen smtp
4304 mode tcp
4305 bind :25
4306 rate-limit sessions 10
4307 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4308
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004309 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4310 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4311 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004312
4313 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4314
4315
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004316redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4317redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4318redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004319 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4321 no | yes | yes | yes
4322
4323 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004324 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004325
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004326 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004327 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
4328 the HTTP "Location" header.
4329
4330 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
4331 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
4332 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
4333 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
4334 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
4335 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie).
4336
4337 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
4338 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
4339 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
4340 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
4341 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
4342 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
4343 returned, which most recent browsers interprete as redirecting to
4344 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
4345 HTTPS.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004346
4347 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4348 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4349 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4350 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4351 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4352 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4353 location with a GET method.
4354
4355 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4356 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4357
4358 - "drop-query"
4359 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4360 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4361 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4362 with a location-type redirect.
4363
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004364 - "append-slash"
4365 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4366 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4367 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4368 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4369
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004370 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4371 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4372 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4373 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4374 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4375 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4376 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4377
4378 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4379 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4380 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4381 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4382 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4383 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4384 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004385
4386 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4387 acl clear dst_port 80
4388 acl secure dst_port 8080
4389 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004390 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004391 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004392 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4393
4394 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004395 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4396 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4397 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004398 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004399
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004400 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4401 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4402 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4403
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004404 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01004405 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02004406
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004407 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004408
4409
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004410redisp (deprecated)
4411redispatch (deprecated)
4412 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4413 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4414 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004415 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004416
4417 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4418 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4419 be able to access the service anymore.
4420
4421 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4422 redistribute them to a working server.
4423
4424 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4425 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4426 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004427
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004428 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4429 "option redispatch" instead.
4430
4431 See also : "option redispatch"
4432
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004433
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004434reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004435 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4437 no | yes | yes | yes
4438 Arguments :
4439 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4440 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004441 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004442
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004443 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4444 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4445
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004446 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4447 the last header of an HTTP request.
4448
4449 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4450 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4451 responses.
4452
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004453 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4454 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4455 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4456
4457 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4458 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004459
4460
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004461reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4462reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004463 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4465 no | yes | yes | yes
4466 Arguments :
4467 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4468 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4469 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4470 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4471 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4472 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4473 ignores case.
4474
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004475 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4476 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4477
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004478 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4479 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4480 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4481 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004482 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004483
4484 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4485 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4486
4487 Example :
4488 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4489 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4490 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4491
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004492 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4493 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004494
4495
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004496reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4497reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004498 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4500 no | yes | yes | yes
4501 Arguments :
4502 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4503 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4504 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4505 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4506 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4507 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4508
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004509 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4510 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4511
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004512 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4513 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4514 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4515 next servers.
4516
4517 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4518 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4519 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4520
4521 Example :
4522 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4523 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4524 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4525
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004526 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4527 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004528
4529
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004530reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4531reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004532 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4534 no | yes | yes | yes
4535 Arguments :
4536 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4537 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4538 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4539 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4540 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4541 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4542 case.
4543
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004544 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4545 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4546
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004547 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4548 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4549 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4550 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004551 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004552
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004553 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004554 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004555 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004556
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004557 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4558 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4559
4560 Example :
4561 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4562 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4563 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4564
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004565 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4566 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004567
4568
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004569reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4570reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004571 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4573 no | yes | yes | yes
4574 Arguments :
4575 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4576 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4577 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4578 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4579 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4580 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4581 case.
4582
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004583 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4584 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4585
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004586 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4587 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4588 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4589 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4590
4591 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4592 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4593
4594 Example :
4595 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4596 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4597 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4598 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4599
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004600 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4601 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004602
4603
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004604reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4605reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004606 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 no | yes | yes | yes
4609 Arguments :
4610 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4611 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4612 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4613 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4614 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4615 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4616
4617 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4618 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4619 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4620 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004621 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004622
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004623 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4624 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4625
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004626 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4627 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4628 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4629
4630 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4631 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4632 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4633 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4634 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4635
4636 Example :
4637 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004638 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004639 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4640 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4641
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04004642 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
4643 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004644
4645
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004646reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4647reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004648 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4650 no | yes | yes | yes
4651 Arguments :
4652 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4653 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4654 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4655 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4656 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4657 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4658 ignores case.
4659
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004660 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4661 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4662
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004663 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4664 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004665 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4666 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4667 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004668 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4669 not set.
4670
4671 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4672 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4673 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4674 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4675 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4676
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004677 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004678 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4679 # block all others.
4680 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4681 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4682
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004683 # block bad guys
4684 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4685 reqitarpit . if badguys
4686
4687 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4688 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004689
4690
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004691retries <value>
4692 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4693 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4694 yes | no | yes | yes
4695 Arguments :
4696 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4697 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4698 default value is 3.
4699
4700 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4701 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4702 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4703
4704 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4705 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4706
4707 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4708 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4709
4710 See also : "option redispatch"
4711
4712
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004713rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004714 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4716 no | yes | yes | yes
4717 Arguments :
4718 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4719 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004720 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004721
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004722 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4723 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4724
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004725 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4726 the last header of an HTTP response.
4727
4728 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4729 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4730 responses.
4731
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004732 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4733 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004734
4735
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004736rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4737rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004738 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4740 no | yes | yes | yes
4741 Arguments :
4742 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4743 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4744 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4745 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4746 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4747 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4748 ignores case.
4749
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004750 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4751 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4752
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004753 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4754 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004755 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004756 client.
4757
4758 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4759 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4760 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4761
4762 Example :
4763 # remove the Server header from responses
4764 reqidel ^Server:.*
4765
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004766 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4767 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004768
4769
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004770rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4771rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004772 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4774 no | yes | yes | yes
4775 Arguments :
4776 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4777 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4778 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4779 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4780 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4781 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4782 ignores case.
4783
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004784 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4785 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4786
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004787 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4788 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4789 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4790 case-sensitive.
4791
4792 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004793 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4794 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4795 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004796
4797 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4798 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4799
4800 Example :
4801 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4802 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4803
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004804 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4805 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004806
4807
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004808rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4809rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004810 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4812 no | yes | yes | yes
4813 Arguments :
4814 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4815 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4816 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4817 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4818 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4819 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4820 ignores case.
4821
4822 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4823 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4824 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4825 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004826 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004827
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004828 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4829 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4830
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004831 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4832 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4833 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4834
4835 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4836 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4837 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4838 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4839 are not case-sensitive.
4840
4841 Example :
4842 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4843 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4844
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004845 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4846 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004847
4848
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004849server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004850 Declare a server in a backend
4851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4852 no | no | yes | yes
4853 Arguments :
4854 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02004855 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004856 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004857
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004858 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4859 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4860 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4861 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004862 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4863 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4864 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4865 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4866 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4867 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004868
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004869 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004870 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4871 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4872 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4873 adding this value to the client's port.
4874
4875 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4876 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004877 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004878
4879 Examples :
4880 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4881 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4882
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004883 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4884 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004885
4886
4887source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004888source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004889source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004890 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4892 yes | no | yes | yes
4893 Arguments :
4894 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4895 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4896 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4897 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4898
4899 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4900 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004901 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4902 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4903 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004904
4905 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4906 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4907 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4908 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4909 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4910 <addr>.
4911
4912 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4913 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4914 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4915 port.
4916
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004917 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4918 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4919 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4920 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4921 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4922 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4923 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4924 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4925 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4926 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4927 HTTP header.
4928
4929 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4930 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004931 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004932 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4933 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4934 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4935 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4936 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4937 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4938 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4939
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004940 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4941 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4942 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4943 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4944 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4945 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4946
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004947 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4948 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4949 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4950 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4951
4952 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4953 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4954 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4955 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4956 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4957 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4958
4959 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4960 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4961 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4962 there are two methods :
4963
4964 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4965 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4966 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4967 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4968 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4969 of the client ranges may be used.
4970
4971 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4972 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4973 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4974 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4975 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4976 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4977 same session.
4978
4979 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4980 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4981 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4982 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4983 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4984 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4985
4986 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4987 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4988 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004989 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004990
4991 Examples :
4992 backend private
4993 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4994 source 192.168.1.200
4995
4996 backend transparent_ssl1
4997 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4998 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4999
5000 backend transparent_ssl2
5001 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5002 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5003 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5004
5005 backend transparent_ssl3
5006 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5007 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5008 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5009
5010 backend transparent_smtp
5011 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5012 # with Tproxy version 4.
5013 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5014
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005015 backend transparent_http
5016 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5017 # proxy.
5018 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5019
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005020 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005021 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5022
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005023
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005024srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5025 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5027 yes | no | yes | yes
5028 Arguments :
5029 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5030 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5031 as explained at the top of this document.
5032
5033 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5034 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5035 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5036 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5037 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5038 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5039 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5040
5041 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5042 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5043 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5044 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5045 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005046 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005047 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005048 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005049
5050 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5051 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5052 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5053 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5054 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5055 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5056
5057 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5058 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5059
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005060 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5061 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005062
5063
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005064stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5065 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5067 no | no | yes | yes
5068
5069 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5070 matched.
5071
5072 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5073 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5074
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005075 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5076 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5077 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5078
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005079 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5080 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5081 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5082 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005083
5084 Example :
5085 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5086 backend stats_localhost
5087 stats enable
5088 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5089
5090 Example :
5091 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5092 backend stats_auth
5093 stats enable
5094 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5095 stats admin if TRUE
5096
5097 Example :
5098 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5099 userlist stats-auth
5100 group admin users admin
5101 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5102 group readonly users haproxy
5103 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5104
5105 backend stats_auth
5106 stats enable
5107 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5108 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5109 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5110 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5111
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005112 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5113 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5114 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005115
5116
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005117stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5118 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5120 yes | no | yes | yes
5121 Arguments :
5122 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5123
5124 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5125
5126 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5127 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5128 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5129 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5130 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5131 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5132
5133 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5134 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5135 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005136 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005137
5138 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5139 report using "stats scope".
5140
5141 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5142 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5143 unobvious parameters.
5144
5145 Example :
5146 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5147 backend public_www
5148 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5149 stats enable
5150 stats hide-version
5151 stats scope .
5152 stats uri /admin?stats
5153 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5154 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5155 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5156
5157 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5158 backend private_monitoring
5159 stats enable
5160 stats uri /admin?stats
5161 stats refresh 5s
5162
5163 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5164
5165
5166stats enable
5167 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5169 yes | no | yes | yes
5170 Arguments : none
5171
5172 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5173 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5174 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5175 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5176 - stats auth : no authentication
5177 - stats scope : no restriction
5178
5179 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5180 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5181 unobvious parameters.
5182
5183 Example :
5184 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5185 backend public_www
5186 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5187 stats enable
5188 stats hide-version
5189 stats scope .
5190 stats uri /admin?stats
5191 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5192 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5193 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5194
5195 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5196 backend private_monitoring
5197 stats enable
5198 stats uri /admin?stats
5199 stats refresh 5s
5200
5201 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5202
5203
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005204stats hide-version
5205 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5207 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005208 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005209
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005210 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5211 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5212 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5213 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5214 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5215 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005217 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5218 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5219 unobvious parameters.
5220
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005221 Example :
5222 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5223 backend public_www
5224 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005225 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005226 stats hide-version
5227 stats scope .
5228 stats uri /admin?stats
5229 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5230 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5231 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005232
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005233 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5234 backend private_monitoring
5235 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005236 stats uri /admin?stats
5237 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005238
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005239 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005240
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005241
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005242stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5243 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5244 Access control for statistics
5245
5246 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5247 no | no | yes | yes
5248
5249 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5250 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5251 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5252 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5253 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5254 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5255
5256 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5257 instance.
5258
5259 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5260 about ACL usage.
5261
5262
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005263stats realm <realm>
5264 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5266 yes | no | yes | yes
5267 Arguments :
5268 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5269 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5270 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5271
5272 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5273 using a backslash ('\').
5274
5275 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5276 only related to authentication.
5277
5278 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5279 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5280 unobvious parameters.
5281
5282 Example :
5283 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5284 backend public_www
5285 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5286 stats enable
5287 stats hide-version
5288 stats scope .
5289 stats uri /admin?stats
5290 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5291 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5292 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5293
5294 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5295 backend private_monitoring
5296 stats enable
5297 stats uri /admin?stats
5298 stats refresh 5s
5299
5300 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5301
5302
5303stats refresh <delay>
5304 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5306 yes | no | yes | yes
5307 Arguments :
5308 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5309 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5310 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5311 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5312 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5313 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5314
5315 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5316 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5317 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5318 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5319
5320 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5321 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5322 unobvious parameters.
5323
5324 Example :
5325 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5326 backend public_www
5327 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5328 stats enable
5329 stats hide-version
5330 stats scope .
5331 stats uri /admin?stats
5332 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5333 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5334 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5335
5336 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5337 backend private_monitoring
5338 stats enable
5339 stats uri /admin?stats
5340 stats refresh 5s
5341
5342 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5343
5344
5345stats scope { <name> | "." }
5346 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5348 yes | no | yes | yes
5349 Arguments :
5350 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5351 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5352 section in which the statement appears.
5353
5354 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5355 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5356 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5357 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5358 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5359 exists.
5360
5361 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5362 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5363 unobvious parameters.
5364
5365 Example :
5366 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5367 backend public_www
5368 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5369 stats enable
5370 stats hide-version
5371 stats scope .
5372 stats uri /admin?stats
5373 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5374 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5375 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5376
5377 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5378 backend private_monitoring
5379 stats enable
5380 stats uri /admin?stats
5381 stats refresh 5s
5382
5383 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5384
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005385
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005386stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005387 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5389 yes | no | yes | yes
5390
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005391 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005392 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5393
5394 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5395 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5396
5397 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5398 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005399 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005400
5401 Example :
5402 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5403 backend private_monitoring
5404 stats enable
5405 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5406 stats uri /admin?stats
5407 stats refresh 5s
5408
5409 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5410 global section.
5411
5412
5413stats show-legends
5414 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5415 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5416 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5417 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5418 - IP (socket, server)
5419 - cookie (backend, server)
5420
5421 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5422 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005423 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005424
5425 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5426
5427
5428stats show-node [ <name> ]
5429 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5431 yes | no | yes | yes
5432 Arguments:
5433 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5434 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5435
5436 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5437 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005438 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005439
5440 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5441 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5442 unobvious parameters.
5443
5444 Example:
5445 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5446 backend private_monitoring
5447 stats enable
5448 stats show-node Europe-1
5449 stats uri /admin?stats
5450 stats refresh 5s
5451
5452 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5453 section.
5454
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005455
5456stats uri <prefix>
5457 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5459 yes | no | yes | yes
5460 Arguments :
5461 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5462 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5463 query string.
5464
5465 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5466 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5467 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5468 possible to reach it in the application.
5469
5470 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005471 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005472 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5473 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5474 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5475 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5476
5477 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5478 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5479 an address or a port to statistics only.
5480
5481 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5482 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5483 unobvious parameters.
5484
5485 Example :
5486 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5487 backend public_www
5488 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5489 stats enable
5490 stats hide-version
5491 stats scope .
5492 stats uri /admin?stats
5493 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5494 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5495 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5496
5497 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5498 backend private_monitoring
5499 stats enable
5500 stats uri /admin?stats
5501 stats refresh 5s
5502
5503 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5504
5505
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005506stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5507 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005509 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005510
5511 Arguments :
5512 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5513 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5514 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5515 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5516
5517 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5518 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5519 the "stick-table" statement.
5520
5521 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5522 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5523 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5524 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5525 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5526
5527 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5528 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5529 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5530 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5531 transformation rules.
5532
5533 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5534 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5535 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5536 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5537 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5538 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5539 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5540
5541 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5542 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5543 ACL based conditions.
5544
5545 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5546 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5547 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5548 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5549
5550 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5551 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5552 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5553 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5554
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005555 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5556 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5557 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5558
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005559 Example :
5560 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5561 # last 30 minutes
5562 backend pop
5563 mode tcp
5564 balance roundrobin
5565 stick store-request src
5566 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5567 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5568 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5569
5570 backend smtp
5571 mode tcp
5572 balance roundrobin
5573 stick match src table pop
5574 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5575 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5576
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005577 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5578 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005579
5580
5581stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5582 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5584 no | no | yes | yes
5585
5586 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5587 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5588 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5589 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5590
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005591 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5592 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5593 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5594
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005595 Examples :
5596 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005597 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005598
5599 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5600 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5601 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5602
5603
5604 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5605 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5606 backend http
5607 mode http
5608 balance roundrobin
5609 stick on src table https
5610 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5611 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5612 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5613
5614 backend https
5615 mode tcp
5616 balance roundrobin
5617 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5618 stick on src
5619 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5620 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5621
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005622 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005623
5624
5625stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5626 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5628 no | no | yes | yes
5629
5630 Arguments :
5631 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5632 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5633 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5634 server is selected.
5635
5636 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5637 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5638 the "stick-table" statement.
5639
5640 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5641 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5642 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5643 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5644 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5645 address.
5646
5647 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5648 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5649 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5650 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5651 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5652 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5653 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5654 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5655 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5656 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5657
5658 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5659 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5660 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5661 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5662 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5663 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5664 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5665
5666 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5667 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5668 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5669 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5670
5671 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5672 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5673 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5674 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5675 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5676 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5677 another protocol or access method.
5678
5679 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5680 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5681 the request.
5682
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005683 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5684 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5685 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5686
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005687 Example :
5688 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5689 # last 30 minutes
5690 backend pop
5691 mode tcp
5692 balance roundrobin
5693 stick store-request src
5694 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5695 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5696 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5697
5698 backend smtp
5699 mode tcp
5700 balance roundrobin
5701 stick match src table pop
5702 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5703 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5704
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005705 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5706 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005707
5708
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005709stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005710 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5711 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005712 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005714 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005715
5716 Arguments :
5717 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5718 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5719 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5720 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5721
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005722 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5723 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5724 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5725 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5726
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005727 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5728 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5729 instance.
5730
5731 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5732 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5733 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5734 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5735 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5736 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005737 to 32 characters.
5738
5739 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5740 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5741 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5742 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5743 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5744 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005745
5746 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005747 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5748 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005749 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5750 increase.
5751
5752 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005753 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5754 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5755 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005756
5757 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5758 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5759 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5760 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5761 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5762 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5763 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5764 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5765 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5766 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5767 parameter (see below).
5768
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005769 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5770 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5771 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5772 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5773 soft restart.
5774
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005775 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5776
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005777 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5778 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5779 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5780 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5781 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005782 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005783 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5784 if not expiration delay is specified.
5785
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005786 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5787 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5788 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5789 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005790 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5791 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5792 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5793 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5794 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5795 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5796 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5797 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5798 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5799 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5800 types and their arguments.
5801
5802 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5803 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5804 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5805 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5806
5807 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5808 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5809 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5810 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5811
5812 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5813 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5814 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5815 they were received.
5816
5817 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5818 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5819 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5820 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5821 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5822
5823 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5824 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5825 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5826 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5827 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5828
5829 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5830 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5831 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5832
5833 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5834 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5835 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5836 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5837 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5838
5839 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5840 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5841 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5842 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5843 the client side.
5844
5845 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5846 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5847 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5848 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5849 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5850 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5851 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5852
5853 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5854 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5855 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5856 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5857 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5858 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5859 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5860
5861 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5862 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5863 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5864 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5865 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5866 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5867
5868 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5869 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5870 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5871 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5872
5873 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5874 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5875 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5876 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5877 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5878 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5879 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5880 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5881 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5882 recommended for better fairness.
5883
5884 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5885 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5886 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5887 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5888
5889 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5890 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5891 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5892 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5893 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5894 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5895 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5896 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5897 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5898 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005899
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005900 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5901 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005902 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5903 reference it.
5904
5905 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5906 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5907 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5908 as an exclusive stickiness.
5909
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005910 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5911 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5912 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5913 something that can be ignored.
5914
5915 Example:
5916 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5917 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5918 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5919 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5920
5921 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005922 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005923
5924
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005925stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5926 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5928 no | no | yes | yes
5929
5930 Arguments :
5931 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5932 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5933 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5934 server is selected.
5935
5936 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5937 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5938 the "stick-table" statement.
5939
5940 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5941 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5942 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5943 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5944
5945 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5946 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5947 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5948 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5949 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5950 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005951 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005952 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5953 rules.
5954
5955 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5956 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5957 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5958 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5959 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5960 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5961 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5962
5963 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5964 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5965 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5966 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5967
5968 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5969 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5970 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5971 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5972 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5973 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5974 another protocol or access method.
5975
5976 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5977
5978 Example :
5979 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5980 backend https
5981 mode tcp
5982 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005983 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005984 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005985
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005986 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5987 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5988
5989 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5990 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5991 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5992
5993 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5994 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005995
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005996 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5997 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5998 # at offset 44.
5999
6000 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6001 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6002
6003 # Learn on response if server hello.
6004 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006005
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006006 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6007 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6008
6009 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6010 extraction.
6011
6012
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006013tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6014 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6016 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006017 Arguments :
6018 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6019 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6020 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006021
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006022 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006023
6024 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6025 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006026 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6027 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6028 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6029 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6030 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6031 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006032
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006033 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6034 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6035 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6036 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006037
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006038 Three types of actions are supported :
6039 - accept :
6040 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6041 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6042 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006043
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006044 - reject :
6045 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6046 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6047 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6048 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6049 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6050 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6051 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6052 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6053 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6054 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6055 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6056 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006058 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6059 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6060 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6061 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6062 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6063 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6064 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6065 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6066 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006067
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006068 These actions take one or two arguments :
6069 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6070 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6071 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006072
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006073 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6074 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6075 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6076 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006077
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006078 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6079 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6080 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6081 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6082 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6083 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6084 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6085 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6086 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6087 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006088
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006089 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6090 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6091 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006092
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006093 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6094 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6095 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006096
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006097 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006098 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006099 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006100
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006101 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6102 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6103 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006104
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006105 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6106 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6107 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006108
6109 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6110
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006111 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006112
6113
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006114tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6115 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006116 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006117 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006118 Arguments :
6119 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6120 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6121 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006122
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006123 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006124
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006125 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6126 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6127 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6128 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6129 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006130
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006131 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6132 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6133 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6134 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6135 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6136 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6137 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6138 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6139 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006140
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006141 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6142 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6143 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6144 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006145
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006146 Three types of actions are supported :
6147 - accept :
6148 - reject :
6149 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006150
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006151 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6152 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006153
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006154 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6155 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6156 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6157 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6158 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6159 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006160
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006161 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006162 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6163 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006164
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006165 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006166 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6167 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6168 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6169 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6170 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006171
6172 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006173 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6174 # and reject everything else.
6175 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6176 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006177 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006178 tcp-request content reject
6179
6180 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006181 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6182 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6183 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006184 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006185
6186 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6187 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6188 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006189 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006190 tcp-request content reject
6191
6192 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6193 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6194
6195 frontend http
6196 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6197 # protecting all our sites
6198 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6199 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6200 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6201 ...
6202 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6203
6204 backend http_dynamic
6205 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6206 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6207 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6208 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6209 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6210 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6211 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006213 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006214
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006215 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006216
6217
6218tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6219 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006221 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006222 Arguments :
6223 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6224 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6225 as explained at the top of this document.
6226
6227 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6228 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6229 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6230 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6231 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6232
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006233 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6234 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6235 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6236 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6237
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006238 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6239 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006240 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006241 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006242 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6243 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6244 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6245 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006246
6247 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6248 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6249 it pass through unaffected.
6250
6251 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6252 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6253 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006254 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006255 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6256 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006257 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6258 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6259 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006260
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006261 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006262 "timeout client".
6263
6264
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006265tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6266 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6268 no | no | yes | yes
6269 Arguments :
6270 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6271 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6272 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6273
6274 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6275
6276 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6277 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6278 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6279 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006280 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006281
6282 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6283
6284 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6285 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6286 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6287 inserted.
6288
6289 Two types of actions are supported :
6290 - accept :
6291 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6292 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6293 the rules evaluation.
6294
6295 - reject :
6296 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6297 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006298 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006299
6300 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6301 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6302 for changing the default action to a reject.
6303
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006304 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
6305 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
6306 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
6307 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006308 period.
6309
6310 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6311
6312 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6313
6314
6315tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6316 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6318 no | no | yes | yes
6319 Arguments :
6320 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6321 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6322 as explained at the top of this document.
6323
6324 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6325
6326
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006327timeout check <timeout>
6328 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6329 established.
6330
6331 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6332 yes | no | yes | yes
6333 Arguments:
6334 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6335 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6336 as explained at the top of this document.
6337
6338 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6339 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6340 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6341 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006342 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6343 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6344 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006345
6346 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6347 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6348
6349 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6350 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006351 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006352
6353 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6354 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6355 forget about it.
6356
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006357 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6358 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006359
6360
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006361timeout client <timeout>
6362timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6363 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6365 yes | yes | yes | no
6366 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006367 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006368 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6369 as explained at the top of this document.
6370
6371 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6372 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6373 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6374 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6375 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6376 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6377 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6378 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006379 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006380 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006381 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6382 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6383 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006384
6385 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6386 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6387 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6388 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6389 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6390 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6391
6392 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6393 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6394 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6395
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006396 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006397
6398
6399timeout connect <timeout>
6400timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6401 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6403 yes | no | yes | yes
6404 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006405 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006406 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6407 as explained at the top of this document.
6408
6409 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006410 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006411 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006412 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006413 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6414 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006415
6416 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6417 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6418 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6419 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6420 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6421 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6422
6423 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6424 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6425 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6426
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006427 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6428 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006429
6430
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006431timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6432 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6434 yes | yes | yes | yes
6435 Arguments :
6436 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6437 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6438 as explained at the top of this document.
6439
6440 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6441 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6442 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6443 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6444 once the request has started to present itself.
6445
6446 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6447 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6448 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6449 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6450 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6451
6452 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6453 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6454 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6455 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6456
6457 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6458 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6459 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6460 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6461 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006462 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006463
6464 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6465 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6466 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6467 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6468
6469 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6470
6471
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006472timeout http-request <timeout>
6473 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006475 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006476 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006477 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006478 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6479 as explained at the top of this document.
6480
6481 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6482 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6483 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6484 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6485 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6486 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6487 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6488 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6489
6490 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6491 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006492 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6493 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006494
6495 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6496 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6497 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6498 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6499 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6500
6501 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006502 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6503 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6504 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006505
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006506 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006507
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006508
6509timeout queue <timeout>
6510 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6512 yes | no | yes | yes
6513 Arguments :
6514 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6515 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6516 as explained at the top of this document.
6517
6518 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6519 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6520 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6521 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6522 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6523
6524 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6525 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6526 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6527 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6528
6529 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6530
6531
6532timeout server <timeout>
6533timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6534 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6536 yes | no | yes | yes
6537 Arguments :
6538 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6539 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6540 as explained at the top of this document.
6541
6542 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6543 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6544 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6545 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6546 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6547 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6548 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6549
6550 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6551 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6552 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6553 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6554 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006555 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006556 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006557 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6558 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6559 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6560 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006561
6562 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6563 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6564 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6565 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6566 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6567 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6568
6569 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6570 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6571 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6572
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006573 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006574
6575
6576timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006577 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6579 yes | yes | yes | yes
6580 Arguments :
6581 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6582 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6583 as explained at the top of this document.
6584
6585 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6586 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6587 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6588
6589 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6590 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6591 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6592 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006593 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006594
6595 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6596
6597
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006598timeout tunnel <timeout>
6599 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6601 yes | no | yes | yes
6602 Arguments :
6603 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6604 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6605 as explained at the top of this document.
6606
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006607 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006608 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6609 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6610 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6611 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6612 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6613 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6614 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6615 specified.
6616
6617 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6618 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6619 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6620 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6621 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6622
6623 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6624 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6625 forget about it.
6626
6627 Example :
6628 defaults http
6629 option http-server-close
6630 timeout connect 5s
6631 timeout client 30s
6632 timeout client 30s
6633 timeout server 30s
6634 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6635
6636 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6637
6638
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006639transparent (deprecated)
6640 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006642 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006643 Arguments : none
6644
6645 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6646 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6647 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6648 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6649 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6650 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6651 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6652 appropriate server.
6653
6654 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6655
6656 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6657 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6658
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006659 See also: "option transparent"
6660
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006661unique-id-format <string>
6662 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6664 yes | yes | yes | no
6665 Arguments :
6666 <string> is a log-format string.
6667
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006668 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6669 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6670 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6671 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006672
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006673 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6674 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6675 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6676 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6677 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6678 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6679 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6680 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006681
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006682 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6683 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006684
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006685 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006686
6687 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6688
6689 will generate:
6690
6691 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6692
6693 See also: "unique-id-header"
6694
6695unique-id-header <name>
6696 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6698 yes | yes | yes | no
6699 Arguments :
6700 <name> is the name of the header.
6701
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006702 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6703 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006704
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006705 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006706
6707 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6708 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6709
6710 will generate:
6711
6712 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6713
6714 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006715
6716use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6717use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006718 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6720 no | yes | yes | no
6721 Arguments :
6722 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006724 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006725
6726 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6727 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6728 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006729 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6730 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6731 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6732 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006733
6734 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6735 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6736 assign the backend.
6737
6738 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6739 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6740 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6741 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6742 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6743 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6744
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006745 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006746 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006747 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6748 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6749 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6750
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006751 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006752
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006753
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006754use-server <server> if <condition>
6755use-server <server> unless <condition>
6756 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6758 no | no | yes | yes
6759 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006760 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006761
6762 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6763
6764 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6765 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6766 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6767
6768 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6769 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6770 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6771 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6772 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6773 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6774 matches will assign the server.
6775
6776 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6777 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6778 with the next rules until one matches.
6779
6780 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6781 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6782 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6783 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6784
6785 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6786 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6787 stripped.
6788
6789 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6790 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6791 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6792 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6793
6794 Example :
6795 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6796 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6797 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6798 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6799 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6800 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6801 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6802 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6803 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6804
6805 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6806
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006807
68085. Bind and Server options
6809--------------------------
6810
6811The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
6812depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
6813settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
6814written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
6815described in this section.
6816
6817
68185.1. Bind options
6819-----------------
6820
6821The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
6822as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
6823no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
6824parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
6825while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
6826provided immediately after the setting name.
6827
6828The currently supported settings are the following ones.
6829
6830accept-proxy
6831 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
6832 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
6833 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
6834 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
6835 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
6836 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
6837 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
6838 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
6839 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
6840 usable.
6841
6842backlog <backlog>
6843 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
6844 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
6845
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02006846ecdhe <named curve>
6847 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6848 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys and makes
6849 ECDHE cipher suites usable.
6850
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006851ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006852 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6853 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
6854 client's certificate.
6855
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006856ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
6857 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6858 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
6859 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
6860 error is ignored.
6861
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006862ciphers <ciphers>
6863 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
6864 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
6865 negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
6866 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
6867 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
6868
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02006869crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02006870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
6871 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
6872 to verify client's certificate.
6873
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006874crt <cert>
6875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6876 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
6877 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006878 files into one. If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters
6879 present in this file are also loaded. If a directory name is used instead of a
6880 PEM file, then all files found in that directory will be loaded. This
6881 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
6882 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
6883 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN
6884 or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is
6885 used instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006886 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org). If no SNI is provided by the
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02006887 client or if the SSL library does not support TLS extensions, or if the client
6888 provides and SNI which does not match any certificate, then the first loaded
6889 certificate will be presented. This means that when loading certificates from
6890 a directory, it is highly recommended to load the default one first as a file.
6891 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006892
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02006893crt-ignore-err <errors>
6894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
6895 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
6896 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not abored if an
6897 error is ignored.
6898
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006899defer-accept
6900 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
6901 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
6902 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
6903 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
6904 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
6905 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
6906 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
6907 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
6908 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
6909 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
6910 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
6911
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02006912force-sslv3
6913 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6914 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
6915 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6916
6917force-tlsv10
6918 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6919 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6920
6921force-tlsv11
6922 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6923 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6924
6925force-tlsv12
6926 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instanciated from
6927 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
6928
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006929gid <gid>
6930 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
6931 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
6932 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
6933 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
6934 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6935
6936group <group>
6937 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
6938 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
6939 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
6940 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
6941 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
6942
6943id <id>
6944 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
6945 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
6946 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
6947 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
6948
6949interface <interface>
6950 Sets the name of the network interface to listen. This is currently only
6951 supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system interface, not an
6952 aliased interface. When specified, all addresses on the same line will only
6953 be accepted if the incoming packets physically come through the designated
6954 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to the same address
6955 if they are bound to different interfaces. Note that binding to a network
6956 interface requires root privileges. This parameter is only compatible with
6957 TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
6958
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02006959level <level>
6960 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
6961 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
6962 sockets. <level> can be one of :
6963 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
6964 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
6965 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
6966 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
6967 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
6968 counters).
6969 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
6970 all counters).
6971
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006972maxconn <maxconn>
6973 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
6974 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
6975 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
6976 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
6977 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
6978 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
6979 eat all memory.
6980
6981mode <mode>
6982 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
6983 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
6984 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
6985 UNIX sockets.
6986
6987mss <maxseg>
6988 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
6989 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
6990 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
6991 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
6992 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
6993 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
6994 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
6995 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
6996 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
6997 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
6998 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
6999
7000name <name>
7001 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
7002 page.
7003
7004nice <nice>
7005 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
7006 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
7007 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
7008 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
7009 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
7010 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
7011 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
7012 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
7013 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
7014 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
7015 one for an RDP socket.
7016
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007017no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007018 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7019 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instanciated from the listener when
7020 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007021 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7022 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007023
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02007024no-tls-tickets
7025 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7026 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7027 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7028 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
7029
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007030no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007032 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7033 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7034 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7035 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007036
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007037no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007039 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7040 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7041 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7042 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007043
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007044no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007045 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007046 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instanciated from the listener
7047 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
7048 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
7049 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007050
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02007051npn <protocols>
7052 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
7053 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
7054 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
7055 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
7056 enabled (check with haproxy -vv).
7057
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007058ssl
7059 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7060 enables SSL deciphering on connections instanciated from this listener. A
7061 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
7062 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
7063 to deciphered contents.
7064
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02007065tfo
7066 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.6. It
7067 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
7068 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
7069 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
7070 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
7071 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
7072 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
7073 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
7074 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7075
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007076transparent
7077 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7078 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
7079 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
7080 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
7081 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
7082 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
7083 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
7084 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
7085 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
7086 so check for support with your vendor.
7087
7088uid <uid>
7089 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
7090 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7091 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
7092 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
7093 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7094
7095user <user>
7096 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
7097 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7098 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
7099 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
7100 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7101
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007102verify [none|optional|required]
7103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7104 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
7105 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
7106 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
7107 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007108 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
7109 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7110 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
7111 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007112
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020071135.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007114------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007116The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
7117which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
7118arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
7119settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
7120after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
7121Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
7122address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007124 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01007125 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007126
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007127The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007128
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007129addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007130 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
7131 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
7132 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
7133 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
7134 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007136 Supported in default-server: No
7137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007138backup
7139 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
7140 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
7141 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
7142 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
7143 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
7144 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007145
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007146 Supported in default-server: No
7147
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007148ca-file <cafile>
7149 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7150 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7151 server's certificate.
7152
7153 Supported in default-server: No
7154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007155check
7156 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01007157 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
7158 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
7159 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
7160 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
7161 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
7162 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
7163 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
7164 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
7165 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
7166 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007168 Supported in default-server: No
7169
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007170check-send-proxy
7171 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
7172 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
7173 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
7174 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
7175 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
7176 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
7177 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
7178
7179 Supported in default-server: No
7180
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007181check-ssl
7182 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
7183 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
7184 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
7185 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
7186 inserts an SSL transport layer below the ckecks, so that a simple TCP connect
7187 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
7188 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
7189 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
7190 See the "ssl" option for more information.
7191
7192 Supported in default-server: No
7193
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007194ciphers <ciphers>
7195 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
7196 is negociated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
7197 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
7198 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
7199 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
7200 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
7201 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
7202 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
7203
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007204 Supported in default-server: No
7205
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007206cookie <value>
7207 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
7208 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
7209 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
7210 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
7211 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
7212 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
7213 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
7214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007215 Supported in default-server: No
7216
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007217crl-file <crlfile>
7218 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7219 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7220 to verify server's certificate.
7221
7222 Supported in default-server: No
7223
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02007224crt <cert>
7225 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7226 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
7227 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
7228 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
7229 certificate request.
7230
7231 Supported in default-server: No
7232
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02007233disabled
7234 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
7235 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
7236 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
7237 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
7238 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
7239
7240 Supported in default-server: No
7241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007242error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007243 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
7244 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
7245 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007246
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007247 Supported in default-server: Yes
7248
7249 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007251fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007252 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
7253 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
7254 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
7255
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007256 Supported in default-server: Yes
7257
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007258force-sslv3
7259 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7260 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
7261 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7262
7263 Supported in default-server: No
7264
7265force-tlsv10
7266 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7267 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7268
7269 Supported in default-server: No
7270
7271force-tlsv11
7272 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7273 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7274
7275 Supported in default-server: No
7276
7277force-tlsv12
7278 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
7279 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
7280
7281 Supported in default-server: No
7282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007283id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007284 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
7285 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
7286 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007288 Supported in default-server: No
7289
7290inter <delay>
7291fastinter <delay>
7292downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007293 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
7294 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
7295 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
7296 between checks depending on the server state :
7297
7298 Server state | Interval used
7299 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7300 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
7301 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7302 Transitionally UP (going down), |
7303 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7304 or yet unchecked. |
7305 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
7306 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
7307 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007309 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
7310 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
7311 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
7312 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
7313 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
7314 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
7315 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
7316 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
7317 servers.
7318
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007319 Supported in default-server: Yes
7320
7321maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007322 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
7323 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
7324 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
7325 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
7326 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
7327 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
7328 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
7329 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
7330
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007331 Supported in default-server: Yes
7332
7333maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007334 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
7335 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
7336 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
7337 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
7338 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
7339 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
7340 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
7341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007342 Supported in default-server: Yes
7343
7344minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007345 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
7346 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
7347 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
7348 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
7349 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
7350 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007351 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007352 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007353
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007354 Supported in default-server: Yes
7355
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007356no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007357 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
7358 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007359 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007360
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007361 Supported in default-server: No
7362
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02007363no-tls-tickets
7364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7365 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
7366 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
7367 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
7368
7369 Supported in default-server: No
7370
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007371no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007372 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007373 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7374 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007375 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7376 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007377
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007378 Supported in default-server: No
7379
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007380no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007381 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007382 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7383 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007384 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7385 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02007386
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007387 Supported in default-server: No
7388
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02007389no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007390 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007391 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
7392 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02007393 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
7394 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007395
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007396 Supported in default-server: No
7397
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09007398non-stick
7399 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
7400 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
7401 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
7402
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007403 Supported in default-server: No
7404
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007405observe <mode>
7406 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
7407 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
7408 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
7409 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
7410 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
7411 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01007412 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007413
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007414 Supported in default-server: No
7415
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007416 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
7417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007418on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007419 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
7420 Currently, four modes are available:
7421 - fastinter: force fastinter
7422 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
7423 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
7424 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
7425 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
7426
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007427 Supported in default-server: Yes
7428
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01007429 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
7430
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007431on-marked-down <action>
7432 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
7433 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007434 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
7435 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
7436 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
7437 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
7438 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
7439 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
7440 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
7441 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09007442
7443 Actions are disabled by default
7444
7445 Supported in default-server: Yes
7446
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07007447on-marked-up <action>
7448 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
7449 Currently one action is available:
7450 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
7451 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
7452 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
7453 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
7454 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
7455 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
7456 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
7457 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
7458
7459 Actions are disabled by default
7460
7461 Supported in default-server: Yes
7462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007463port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007464 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
7465 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
7466 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
7467 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
7468 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
7469 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
7470
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007471 Supported in default-server: Yes
7472
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007473redir <prefix>
7474 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
7475 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
7476 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
7477 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
7478 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
7479 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
7480 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
7481 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007482 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007483 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
7484 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
7485 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
7486 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
7487 loop between the client and HAProxy!
7488
7489 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
7490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007491 Supported in default-server: No
7492
7493rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007494 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
7495 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7496 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7497
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007498 Supported in default-server: Yes
7499
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007500send-proxy
7501 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7502 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7503 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7504 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7505 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7506 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7507 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7508 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7509 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02007510 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
7511 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
7512 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
7513 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
7514 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007515
7516 Supported in default-server: No
7517
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007518slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007519 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7520 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7521 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7522 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7523 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7524 parameters :
7525
7526 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7527 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7528
7529 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7530 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7531 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7532 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7533
7534 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7535 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7536 seen as failed.
7537
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007538 Supported in default-server: Yes
7539
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007540source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007541source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007542source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007543 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7544 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7545 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7546 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7547
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007548 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7549 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7550 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7551 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7552 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7553 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7554 server.
7555
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007556 Supported in default-server: No
7557
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007558ssl
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007559 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. At
7560 the moment, server certificates are not checked, so this is prone to man in
7561 the middle attacks. The real intended use is to permit SSL communication
7562 with software which cannot work in other modes over networks that would
7563 otherwise be considered safe enough for clear text communications. When this
7564 option is used, health checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there
7565 is a "port" or an "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a
7566 different location. See the "check-ssl" optino to force SSL health checks.
7567
7568 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02007569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007570track [<proxy>/]<server>
7571 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7572 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7573 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7574 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7575 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007577 Supported in default-server: No
7578
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02007579verify [none|required]
7580 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
7581 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. This is the default. In the
7582 other case, The certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from
7583 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
7584 is aborted.
7585
7586 Supported in default-server: No
7587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007588weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007589 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7590 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7591 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007592 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7593 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7594 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7595 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7596 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7597 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007598
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007599 Supported in default-server: Yes
7600
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007601
76026. HTTP header manipulation
7603---------------------------
7604
7605In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7606response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7607request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7608which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7609against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7610to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7611passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7612headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7613never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7614
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007615There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7616(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7617rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7618messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7619in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007620happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007621add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7622normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7623
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007624This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7625in section 4.2 :
7626
7627 - reqadd <string>
7628 - reqallow <search>
7629 - reqiallow <search>
7630 - reqdel <search>
7631 - reqidel <search>
7632 - reqdeny <search>
7633 - reqideny <search>
7634 - reqpass <search>
7635 - reqipass <search>
7636 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7637 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7638 - reqtarpit <search>
7639 - reqitarpit <search>
7640 - rspadd <string>
7641 - rspdel <search>
7642 - rspidel <search>
7643 - rspdeny <search>
7644 - rspideny <search>
7645 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7646 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7647
7648With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7649is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7650parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7651prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7652Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7653
7654 \t for a tab
7655 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7656 \n for a new line (LF)
7657 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7658 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7659 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7660 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7661 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7662
7663The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7664portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7665above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7666regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
76679 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7668is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7669
7670The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7671after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7672
7673Notes related to these keywords :
7674---------------------------------
7675 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7676 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7677 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7678
7679 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7680 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7681 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7682
7683 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7684 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7685 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7686 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7687 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7688
7689 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7690 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7691 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7692 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7693 useless headers before adding new ones.
7694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007695 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007696 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7697
7698 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7699 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7700 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7701
7702 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7703 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007704 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007705
7706
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010077077. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7708------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007709
7710The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7711content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7712from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7713simple :
7714
7715 - define test criteria with sets of values
7716 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7717
7718The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7719
7720In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7721
7722 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7723
7724This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7725Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7726and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7727an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7728of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7729
7730ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7731'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7732which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7733
7734There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7735performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7736
7737The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7738
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007739 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7740 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007741 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7742
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007743The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7744specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7745possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007746multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7747be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7748needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7749space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7750match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7751lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7752duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007753to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceding it. For
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007754instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007755
7756 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7757
7758In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7759the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7760case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7761too.
7762
7763Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7764a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7765ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7766
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007767Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007768
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007769 - integers or integer ranges
7770 - strings
7771 - regular expressions
7772 - IP addresses and networks
7773
7774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020077757.1. Matching integers
7776----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007777
7778Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7779that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7780expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7781may be omitted.
7782
7783For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7784unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7785representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7786
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007787As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7788two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7789instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7790ranges and operators.
7791
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007792For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007793operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7794Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7795of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007797Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007798
7799 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7800 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7801 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7802 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7803 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7804
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007805For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007806
7807 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7808
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007809This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7810
7811 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7812
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007813
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078147.2. Matching strings
7815---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007816
7817String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7818exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7819characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7820string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7821to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007822before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007823
7824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078257.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7826-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007827
7828Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7829they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7830possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7831passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7832the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007833the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7834match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007835
7836
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020078377.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007838----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007839
7840IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7841netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7842within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007843host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007844difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7845at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7846does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7847parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007848
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007849IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7850Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7851trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7852IPv6 patterns.
7853
7854HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7855following situations :
7856 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7857 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7858 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7859 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7860 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7861 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7862 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7863 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7864 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7865 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7866
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078687.5. Available matching criteria
7869--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020078717.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7872------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007873
7874A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7875analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007876addresses and ports, as well as internal values independent on the stream.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007877
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007878always_false
7879 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7880 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7881
7882always_true
7883 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7884 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7885
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007886avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007887avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007888 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7889 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7890 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7891 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7892 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7893 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7894 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7895 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7896 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7897 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7898 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007899
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007900be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007901be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007902 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7903 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7904 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7905 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7906 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007907
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007908be_id <integer>
7909 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7910 backend it was called.
7911
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007912be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007913be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007914 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7915 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7916 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7917 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7918 sucking of an online dictionary).
7919
7920 Example :
7921 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7922 backend dynamic
7923 mode http
7924 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7925 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007926
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007927connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007928connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007929 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007930 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007931 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7932
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007933 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7934 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007935
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007936 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007937 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7938 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7939 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7940 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7941 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007942 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007943
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007944 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7945 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7946 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7947 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007948
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007949dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007950 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7951 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007952
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007953dst_conn <integer>
7954 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7955 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7956 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7957 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7958 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7959 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7960
7961dst_port <integer>
7962 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7963 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7964
7965fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007966fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007967 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7968 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7969 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7970 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7971 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7972 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7973 criteria.
7974
7975fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007976 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007977 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007978
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007979fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007980fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007981 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7982 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7983 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7984 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7985 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7986 the rate to go down below the limit.
7987
7988 Example :
7989 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7990 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7991 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7992 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7993 frontend mail
7994 bind :25
7995 mode tcp
7996 maxconn 100
7997 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7998 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7999 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
8000 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008001
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008002nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008003nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008004 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
8005 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
8006 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
8007 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
8008 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008009
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008010queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008011queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008012 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
8013 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
8014 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
8015 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
8016 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
8017 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
8018 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
8019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008020sc1_bytes_in_rate
8021sc2_bytes_in_rate
8022 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
8023 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8024 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
8025
8026sc1_bytes_out_rate
8027sc2_bytes_out_rate
8028 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
8029 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
8030 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
8031
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008032sc1_clr_gpc0
8033sc2_clr_gpc0
8034 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
8035 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
8036 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
8037 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
8038 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
8039 was verified :
8040
8041 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8042 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8043 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8044 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8045 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
8046 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8047 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008049sc1_conn_cnt
8050sc2_conn_cnt
8051 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
8052 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
8053
8054sc1_conn_cur
8055sc2_conn_cur
8056 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
8057 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
8058 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
8059
8060sc1_conn_rate
8061sc2_conn_rate
8062 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
8063 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
8064 See also src_conn_rate.
8065
8066sc1_get_gpc0
8067sc2_get_gpc0
8068 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8069 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
8070
8071sc1_http_err_cnt
8072sc2_http_err_cnt
8073 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
8074 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
8075 See also src_http_err_cnt.
8076
8077sc1_http_err_rate
8078sc2_http_err_rate
8079 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
8080 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
8081 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
8082 src_http_err_rate.
8083
8084sc1_http_req_cnt
8085sc2_http_req_cnt
8086 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8087 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8088 src_http_req_cnt.
8089
8090sc1_http_req_rate
8091sc2_http_req_rate
8092 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
8093 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
8094 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
8095 src_http_req_rate.
8096
8097sc1_inc_gpc0
8098sc2_inc_gpc0
8099 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
8100 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
8101 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
8102 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
8103 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
8104 when a first ACL was verified :
8105
8106 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8107 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
8108 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8109
8110sc1_kbytes_in
8111sc2_kbytes_in
8112 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
8113 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8114 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8115 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
8116
8117sc1_kbytes_out
8118sc2_kbytes_out
8119 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
8120 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
8121 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
8122 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
8123
8124sc1_sess_cnt
8125sc2_sess_cnt
8126 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
8127 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
8128 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
8129 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008130 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008131 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
8132
8133sc1_sess_rate
8134sc2_sess_rate
8135 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
8136 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
8137 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
8138 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
8139 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008140 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008141
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008142so_id <integer>
8143 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
8144
8145src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008146 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
8147 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
8148 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008149
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008150src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008151src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008152 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8153 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8154 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008155 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008156
8157src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008158src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008159 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
8160 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8161 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008162 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008163
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02008164src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
8165src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
8166 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8167 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8168 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
8169 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
8170 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
8171 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8172
8173 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
8174 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
8175 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8176 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
8177 acl save src_clr_gpc0
8178 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
8179 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
8180
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008181src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008182src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008183 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8184 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8185 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008186 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008187
8188src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008189src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008190 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
8191 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
8192 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008193 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008194
8195src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008196src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008197 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
8198 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8199 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008200 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008201
8202src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008203src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008204 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
8205 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
8206 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008207 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008208
8209src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008210src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008211 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
8212 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8213 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008214 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008215
8216src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008217src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008218 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
8219 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
8220 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
8221 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008222 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008223
8224src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008225src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008226 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8227 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8228 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008229 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008230
8231src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008232src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008233 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
8234 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8235 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
8236 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008237 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008238
8239src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008240src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008241 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
8242 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
8243 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
8244 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
8245 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
8246 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
8247
8248 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
8249 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008250 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008251
8252src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008253src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008254 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
8255 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8256 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8257 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008258 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008259
8260src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008261src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008262 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
8263 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
8264 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
8265 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008266 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008267
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008268src_port <integer>
8269 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01008270
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008271src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008272src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008273 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
8274 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
8275 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
8276 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008277 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008278
8279src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008280src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008281 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
8282 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
8283 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
8284 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008285 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008286
8287src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008288src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008289 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008290 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
8291 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008292 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
8293 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
8294 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008295 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008296
8297 Example :
8298 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
8299 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
8300 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
8301 listen ssh
8302 bind :22
8303 mode tcp
8304 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008305 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02008306 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
8307 server local 127.0.0.1:22
8308
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008309srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02008310 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
8311 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
8312 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
8313 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
8314
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01008315srv_id <integer>
8316 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
8317
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02008318srv_is_up(<server>)
8319srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
8320 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
8321 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
8322 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
8323 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
8324 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
8325 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
8326 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
8327 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
8328
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008329table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008330table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008331 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
8332 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
8333
8334table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008335table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02008336 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
8337 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
8338 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
8339
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008340
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020083417.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
8342---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008343
8344A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
8345during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008346through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
8347keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008348
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008349rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8350 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8351 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8352 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008353 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8354 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8355 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008356
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008357req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008358 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008359 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
8360 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
8361 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
8362 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
8363 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
8364 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
8365
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008366req_proto_http
8367 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
8368 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008369 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008370 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
8371 using TCP request content inspection rules.
8372
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008373req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008374req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008375 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
8376 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
8377 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
8378 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
8379 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
8380 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
8381 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
8382 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
8383
8384req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008385req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008386 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
8387 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
8388 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
8389 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
8390 cookies.
8391
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008392req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
8393 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8394 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
8395 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008396 SSL session ID may be fetched. Note that this only applies to raw contents
8397 found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data
8398 layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008399
8400req_ssl_sni <string>
8401 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
8402 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8403 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
8404 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
8405 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
8406 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
8407 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008408 hello (type 1), like in the example below. Note that this only applies to raw
8409 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008410 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008411 option. See also "ssl_sni" below.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01008412
8413 Examples :
8414 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
8415 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8416 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
8417 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
8418 default_backend bk_sorry_page
8419
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008420req_ssl_ver <decimal>
8421 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
8422 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
8423 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
8424 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
8425 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
8426 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008427 with TCP request content inspection. Note that this only applies to raw
8428 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008429 SSL transport layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008430 option.
8431
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008432ssl_c_ca_err <integer>
8433 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8434 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification of the
8435 client certificate at depth > 0 matches the specified value (check man verify
8436 for possible values). Note that error zero means no error was encountered
8437 during this verification process.
8438
8439ssl_c_ca_err_depth <integer>
8440 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8441 layer, and the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
8442 verification of the client certificate matches the specified value. When no
8443 error is found, depth 0 is returned.
8444
8445ssl_c_err <integer>
8446 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8447 layer, and the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth==0
8448 matches the specified value (check man verify for possible values). Note that
8449 error zero means no error was encountered during this verification process.
8450
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008451ssl_c_i_dn <string>
8452ssl_c_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8453 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8454 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8455 issuer of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8456 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8457 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8458 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8459 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8460 DN matches the specified string.
8461
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008462ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8463 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8464 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8465 certificate presented by the client matches the string.
8466
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008467ssl_c_notafter <string>
8468 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8469 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8470 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8471
8472ssl_c_notbefore <string>
8473 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8474 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the client matches
8475 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8476
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008477ssl_c_s_dn <string>
8478ssl_c_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8479 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8480 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8481 subject of the certificate presented by the client matches the specified
8482 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8483 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8484 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8485 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8486 DN matches the specified string.
8487
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008488ssl_c_serial <hexa>
8489 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8490 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the client matches
8491 the value written in hexa.
8492
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008493ssl_c_sig_alg <string>
8494 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8495 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8496 by the client matches the string.
8497
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008498ssl_c_verify <integer>
8499 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8500 layer, and the verify result matches the specified value (check man verify
8501 for possible values). Zero indicates no error was detected.
8502
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008503ssl_c_version <integer>
8504 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8505 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the client matches
8506 the value.
8507
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008508ssl_f_i_dn <string>
8509ssl_f_i_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8510 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8511 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8512 issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8513 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8514 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8515 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8516 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8517 DN matches the specified string.
8518
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008519ssl_c_key_alg <string>
8520 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8521 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the
8522 certificate presented by the frontend matches the string.
8523
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02008524ssl_f_notafter <string>
8525 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8526 layer, and the end date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8527 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8528
8529ssl_f_notbefore <string>
8530 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8531 layer, and the start date of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8532 the string formatted as YYMMDDhhmmss[Z].
8533
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02008534ssl_f_s_dn <string>
8535ssl_f_s_dn(entry[,occ]) <string>
8536 If no entry specified, returns true when the incoming connection was made
8537 over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and the full distinguished name of the
8538 subject of the certificate presented by the frontend matches the specified
8539 string. Otherwise returns true if the value of the first given entry from
8540 the beginning of the DN matches the specified string. If a positive/negative
8541 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
8542 true if the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the
8543 DN matches the specified string.
8544
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02008545ssl_f_serial <hexa>
8546 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8547 layer, and the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8548 the value written in hexa.
8549
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02008550ssl_f_sig_alg <string>
8551 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8552 layer, and the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented
8553 by the frontend matches the string.
8554
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02008555ssl_f_version <integer>
8556 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8557 layer, and the version of the certificate presented by the frontend matches
8558 the value.
8559
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008560ssl_fc
8561 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
8562 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
8563 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
8564
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008565ssl_fc_alg_keysize <integer>
8566 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8567 layer and the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits matches the value.
8568
8569ssl_fc_cipher <string>
8570 returns true when the incoming connection was made over an ssl/tls transport
8571 layer and the name of the used cipher matches the string.
8572
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008573ssl_fc_has_crt
8574 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
8575 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
8576
8577ssl_fc_has_sni
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008578 This is used to check for presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008579 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
8580 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
8581 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8582 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008583
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008584ssl_fc_npn <string>
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008585 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8586 layer which deciphered it and found a Next Protocol Negociation TLS extension
8587 sent by the client, matching the specified string. This requires that the SSL
8588 library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008589 Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on
8590 the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to
8591 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be requested.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02008592
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008593ssl_fc_protocol <string>
8594 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8595 layer and the name of the used protocol matches the string.
8596
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008597ssl_fc_sni <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008598 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8599 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8600 sent by the client, matching the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8601 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008602 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8603 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008604 See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_req" below. This requires that the
8605 SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
8606 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008607
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008608ssl_fc_sni_end <string>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008609 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8610 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8611 sent by the client, ending like the specified string. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8612 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008613 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8614 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8615 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8616 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02008617
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02008618ssl_fc_sni_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02008619 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8620 layer which deciphered it and found a Server Name Indication TLS extension
8621 sent by the client, matching the specified regex. In HTTPS, the SNI field
8622 (when present) is equal to the requested host name. This match is different
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +02008623 from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the connection being
8624 deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly forwarded. This
8625 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
8626 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008627
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02008628ssl_fc_use_keysize <integer>
8629 Returns true when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
8630 layer and the symmetric cipher key size used in bits matches the value.
8631
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02008632wait_end
8633 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
8634 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
8635 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
8636 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
8637 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
8638 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
8639 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
8640 inspection.
8641
8642 Examples :
8643 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
8644 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
8645 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
8646
8647 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
8648 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
8649 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
8650 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
8651 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
8652 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
8653 tcp-request content reject
8654
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086567.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
8657--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008658
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008659A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008660application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
8661read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
8662than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
8663
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008664base <string>
8665 Returns true when the concatenation of the first Host header and the path
8666 part of the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the
8667 question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be used to match known
8668 files in virtual hosting environments, such as "www.example.com/favicon.ico".
8669 See also "path" and "uri".
8670
8671base_beg <string>
8672 Returns true when the base (see above) begins with one of the strings. This
8673 can be used to send certain directory names to alternative backends. See also
8674 "path_beg".
8675
8676base_dir <string>
8677 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8678 slashes in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "url_dir" and
8679 "path_dir" instead.
8680
8681base_dom <string>
8682 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8683 in the base (see above). Probably of little use, see "path_dom" and "url_dom"
8684 instead.
8685
8686base_end <string>
8687 Returns true when the base (see above) ends with one of the strings. This may
8688 be used to control file name extension, though "path_end" is cheaper.
8689
8690base_len <integer>
8691 Returns true when the base (see above) length matches the values or ranges
8692 specified. This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8693
8694base_reg <regex>
8695 Returns true when the base (see above) matches one of the regular
8696 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8697 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg", "url_reg"
8698 and all "base_" criteria.
8699
8700base_sub <string>
8701 Returns true when the base (see above) contains one of the strings. It can be
8702 used to detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See
8703 also "base_dir".
8704
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008705cook(<name>) <string>
8706 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
8707 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
8708 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
8709 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
8710 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
8711 sent by the server.
8712
8713 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
8714 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
8715 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
8716
8717 cook(profile) silver gold
8718
8719cook_beg(<name>) <string>
8720 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
8721 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8722 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8723
8724cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
8725 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
8726 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
8727 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
8728 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
8729 server.
8730
8731cook_dir(<name>) <string>
8732 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8733 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8734 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
8735 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
8736 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8737
8738cook_dom(<name>) <string>
8739 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
8740 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
8741 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8742 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8743
8744cook_end(<name>) <string>
8745 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
8746 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8747 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8748
8749cook_len(<name>) <integer>
8750 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
8751 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8752 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
8753 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
8754 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8755
8756cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
8757 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
8758 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
8759 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
8760 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8761 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8762
8763cook_sub(<name>) <string>
8764 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
8765 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8766 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8767
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02008768cook_val(<name>) <integer>
8769 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
8770 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8771 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8772 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8773 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8774
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008775hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008776hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008777 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8778 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8779 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8780 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008781 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8782 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8783 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8784 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8785 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008786
8787 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008788 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008789 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8790
8791 hdr(Connection) -i close
8792
8793hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008794hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008795 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8796 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8797 response headers sent by the server.
8798
8799hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008800hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008801 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8802 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8803 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8804 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8805 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8806 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8807 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8808
8809hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008810hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008811 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8812 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8813 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8814 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8815 headers sent by the server.
8816
8817hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008818hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008819 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8820 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8821 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8822 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8823 server.
8824
8825hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008826hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008827 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8828 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8829 response headers sent by the server.
8830
8831hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008832hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8833 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8834 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8835 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008836 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8837
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008838hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008839hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008840 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8841 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8842 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8843 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8844
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008845hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008846hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008847 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008848 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8849 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8850 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8851 response headers sent by the server.
8852
8853hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008854hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008855 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8856 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8857 response headers sent by the server.
8858
8859hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008860hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008861 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8862 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8863 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8864 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8865
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008866http_auth(<userlist>)
8867http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008868 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8869 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8870 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8871 of specified groups.
8872
8873 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8874
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008875http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008876 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8877 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8878 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8879 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8880
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008881method <string>
8882 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8883 already check for most common methods.
8884
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008885path <string>
8886 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8887 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8888 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8889
8890path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008891 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8892 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008893
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008894path_dir <string>
8895 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8896 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8897 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8898 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8899
8900path_dom <string>
8901 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8902 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8903 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8904
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008905path_end <string>
8906 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8907 control file name extension.
8908
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008909path_len <integer>
8910 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8911 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8912
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008913path_reg <regex>
8914 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8915 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8916 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8917
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008918path_sub <string>
8919 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8920 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8921 "path_dir".
8922
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008923payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8924 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8925 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8926 strings.
8927
8928payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8929 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8930 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8931 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8932 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8933 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8934
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008935req_ver <string>
8936 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8937 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8938
8939status <integer>
8940 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8941 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8942 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8943
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008944url <string>
8945 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008946 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL. See also "base".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008947
8948url_beg <string>
8949 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008950 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme. See also
8951 "base_beg".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008952
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008953url_dir <string>
8954 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8955 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8956 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8957 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8958
8959url_dom <string>
8960 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8961 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8962 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8963
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008964url_end <string>
8965 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8966 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008967
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008968url_ip <address>
8969 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8970 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8971 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008972
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008973url_len <integer>
8974 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8975 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8976
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008977url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008978 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8979 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008980 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008981 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008982
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008983url_reg <regex>
8984 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8985 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02008986 than other methods. See also "base_reg", "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008987
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008988url_sub <string>
8989 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8990 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008991
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008992urlp(<name>) <string>
8993 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8994 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8995
8996 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8997 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8998
8999urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
9000 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
9001 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
9002 protocol scheme.
9003
9004urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
9005 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
9006 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
9007 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
9008 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
9009
9010urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
9011 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
9012 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
9013 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
9014 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
9015
9016urlp_end(<name>) <string>
9017 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
9018
9019urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009020 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
9021 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009022
9023urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
9024 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
9025 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
9026
9027urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
9028 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
9029 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
9030 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
9031 "urlp_" criteria.
9032
9033urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
9034 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
9035 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
9036 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
9037
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +02009038urlp_val(<name>) <integer>
9039 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" starts with a number matching
9040 the values or ranges specified. Note that the absence of the parameter does
9041 not match anything. Integers are unsigned so it is not possible to match
9042 negative data.
9043
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090457.6. Pre-defined ACLs
9046---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009048Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
9049every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009050order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009051
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009052ACL name Equivalent to Usage
9053---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009054FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02009055HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009056HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
9057HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009058HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
9059HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
9060HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
9061HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
9062LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009063METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
9064METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
9065METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
9066METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
9067METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
9068METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02009069RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009070REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009071TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009072WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
9073---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009074
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009075
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020090767.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
9077----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009079Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9080combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009081
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009082 - AND (implicit)
9083 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9084 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009085
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009086A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009088 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009090Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9091indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009093For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9094"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9095requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9096is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009097
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009098 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9099 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9100 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9101 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009103To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9104and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009106 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9107 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9108 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9109 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009111 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9112 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9113 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9114 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009115
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009116It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9117expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9118be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009119the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01009120
9121 The following rule :
9122
9123 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9124 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9125
9126 Can also be written that way :
9127
9128 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9129
9130It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9131to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9132simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9133sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9134good use is the following :
9135
9136 With named ACLs :
9137
9138 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9139 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9140 monitor fail if site_dead
9141
9142 With anonymous ACLs :
9143
9144 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009146See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01009147
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01009148
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010091497.8. Pattern extraction
9150-----------------------
9151
9152The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
9153response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
9154for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
9155
9156All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
9157"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
9158begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
9159arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
9160much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
9161equivalent used in ACLs.
9162
9163The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
9164
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +02009165 base This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the
9166 path part of the request, which starts at the first slash and
9167 ends before the question mark. It can be useful in virtual
9168 hosted environments to detect URL abuses as well as to improve
9169 shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size stick
9170 table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
9171 requested objects by host/path.
9172
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009173 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009174 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9175 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9176 according to RFC 4291.
9177
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009178 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
9179 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
9180 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009181 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9182 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
9183 according to RFC 4291.
9184
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009185 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
9186 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
9187 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
9188 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
9189 type integer and only works with such tables.
9190
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02009191 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
9192 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
9193 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
9194 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
9195 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
9196 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
9197 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01009198 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02009199
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009200 path This extracts the request's URL path (without the host part). A
9201 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9202 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9203 keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing caches, it would be
9204 wiser to use "url" instead.
9205
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009206 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009207 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
9208 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
9209 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
9210 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009211
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009212 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009213 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
9214 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
9215 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
9216 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
9217 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
9218 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
9219 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
9220 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009221
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02009222 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
9223 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
9224 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
9225 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
9226
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009227 ssl_c_ca_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9228 client certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was detected.
9229
9230 ssl_c_ca_err_depth
9231 Returns the depth of the first error detected during verify. If
9232 no error is encountered in the CA chain, zero is returned.
9233
9234 ssl_c_err Returns the ID of the first error detected during verify of the
9235 client certificate at depth == 0, or 0 if no errors.
9236
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009237 ssl_c_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9238 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9239 the issuer of the certificate presented by the client when
9240 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9241 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9242 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9243 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9244 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9245 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9246 name ssl_c_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9247 ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2).
9248
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009249 ssl_c_key_alg
9250 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9251 the certificate presented by the client when the incoming
9252 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9253
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009254 ssl_c_notafter
9255 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted
9256 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9257 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9258
9259 ssl_c_notbefore
9260 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted
9261 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9262 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9263
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009264 ssl_c_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9265 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9266 the subject of the certificate presented by the client when
9267 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9268 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9269 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9270 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9271 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9272 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9273 name ssl_c_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9274 ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2).
9275
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009276 ssl_c_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client
9277 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9278 layer.
9279
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009280 ssl_c_sig_alg
9281 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9282 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made
9283 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9284
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009285 ssl_c_verify Returns the verify result errorID when the incoming connection
9286 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no
9287 error is encountered.
9288
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009289 ssl_c_version
9290 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client
9291 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9292 layer.
9293
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009294 ssl_f_i_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9295 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9296 the issuer of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9297 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9298 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9299 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9300 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9301 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9302 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9303 name ssl_f_i_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9304 ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2).
9305
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009306 ssl_f_key_alg
9307 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of
9308 the certificate presented by the frontend when the incoming
9309 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9310
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +02009311 ssl_f_notafter
9312 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9313 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9314 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9315
9316 ssl_f_notbefore
9317 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted
9318 string YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made
9319 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9320
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +02009321 ssl_f_s_dn[(entry[,occ])]
9322 If no entry specified, returns the full distinguished name of
9323 the subject of the certificate presented by the frontend when
9324 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9325 layer. Otherwise returns the the value of the first given entry
9326 found from the the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
9327 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument,
9328 it returns the value of the nth given entry found from the
9329 beginning/end of the DN. For instance to retrieve the common
9330 name ssl_f_s_dn(CN) and the second organization unit
9331 ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2).
9332
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +02009333 ssl_f_serial Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend
9334 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9335 layer.
9336
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +02009337 ssl_f_sig_alg
9338 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate
9339 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made
9340 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9341
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +02009342 ssl_f_version
9343 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend
9344 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
9345 layer.
9346
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009347 ssl_fc This checks the transport layer used on the front connection,
9348 and returns 1 if it was made via an SSL/TLS transport layer,
9349 otherwise zero.
9350
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009351 ssl_fc_alg_keysize
9352 Returns the symmetric cipher key size support d in bits when the
9353 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9354
9355 ssl_fc_cipher
9356 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection
9357 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9358
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009359 ssl_fc_has_crt
9360 Returns 1 if a client certificate is present in the front
9361 connection over SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise 0.
9362
9363 ssl_fc_has_sni
9364 This checks the transport layer used by the front connection, and
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009365 returns 1 if the connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
9366 layer and the client sent a Server Name Indication TLS extension,
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009367 otherwise zero. This requires that the SSL library is build with
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009368 support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009369
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009370 ssl_fc_npn This extracts the Next Protocol Negociation field from an
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009371 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and
9372 locally deciphered by haproxy. The result is a string containing
9373 the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL library must
9374 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009375 haproxy -vv). See also the "npn" bind keyword.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +02009376
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009377 ssl_fc_protocol
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01009378 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming
9379 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009380
Emeric Brunfe68f682012-10-16 14:59:28 +02009381 ssl_fc_session_id
9382 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming
9383 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful to
9384 stick on a given client.
9385
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +02009386 ssl_fc_sni This extracts the Server Name Indication field from an incoming
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +02009387 connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
9388 deciphered by haproxy. The result typically is a string matching
9389 the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must
9390 have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
9391 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +02009392
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +02009393 ssl_fc_use_keysize
9394 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the
9395 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
9396
Willy Tarreau6812bcf2012-04-29 09:28:50 +02009397 url This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A
9398 typical use is with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals
9399 which need to aggregate multiple information from databases and
9400 keep them in caches. See also "path".
9401
9402 url_ip This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the
9403 host part is presented as an IP address. Its use is very
9404 limited. For instance, a monitoring system might use this field
9405 as an alternative for the source IP in order to test what path a
9406 given source address would follow, or to force an entry in a
9407 table for a given source address.
9408
9409 url_port This extracts the port part from the request's URL. It probably
9410 is totally useless but it was available at no cost.
9411
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009412 url_param(<name>[,<delim>])
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009413 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
bedis4c75cca2012-10-05 08:38:24 +02009414 the parameter string of the request and uses the corresponding
9415 value to match. Optionally, a delimiter can be provided. If not
9416 then the question mark '?' is used by default.
9417 A typical use is to get sticky session through url for cases
9418 where cookies cannot be used.
9419
9420 Example :
9421 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
9422 stick on url_param(PHPSESSIONID)
9423 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
9424 stick on url_param(JSESSIONID,;)
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09009425
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009426 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009427 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
9428 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
9429 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
9430 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009431
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009432 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
9433 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
9434 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
9435 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
9436 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
9437 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
9438 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009439
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009440 Example :
9441 listen tse-farm
9442 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
9443 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9444 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9445 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9446 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9447 persist rdp-cookie
9448 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
9449 # This is only useful makes sense if
9450 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
9451 stick-table type string size 204800
9452 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
9453 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9454 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009455
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009456 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
9457 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009458
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009459 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009460 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009461 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
9462 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
9463 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
9464 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
9465 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
9466 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009467
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009468 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009469
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009470 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02009471 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
9472 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
9473 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
9474
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009475 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
9476 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
9477 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
9478 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
9479 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009480
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009481 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02009482
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009483
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009484The currently available list of transformations include :
9485
9486 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
9487 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9488 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9489
9490 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
9491 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
9492 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
9493
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009494 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01009495 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
9496 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
9497 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
9498 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
9499
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009500
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095018. Logging
9502----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009503
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009504One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
9505provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
9506very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
9507provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
9508state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009509to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009510headers.
9511
9512In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
9513about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
9514send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
9515
9516 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
9517 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
9518 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
9519 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
9520 at the termination.
9521
9522The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
9523allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
9524as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
9525while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
9526real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
9527delay.
9528
9529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095308.1. Log levels
9531---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009532
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009533TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009534source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009535HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
9536in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
9537track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
9538syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
9539about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009540
9541
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095428.2. Log formats
9543----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009544
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009545HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09009546and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
9547slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
9548options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009549
9550 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
9551 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
9552 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
9553 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
9554 extents.
9555
9556 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
9557 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
9558 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
9559 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
9560 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
9561
9562 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
9563 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
9564 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
9565 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
9566 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
9567
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009568 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
9569 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
9570 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
9571 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
9572
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009573 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
9574
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009575Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
9576specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
9577field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
9578servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
9579always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
9580identifier.
9581
9582Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
9583 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
9584 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
9585 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
9586 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
9587
9588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095898.2.1. Default log format
9590-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009591
9592This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
9593as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
9594format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
9595
9596 Example :
9597 listen www
9598 mode http
9599 log global
9600 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9601
9602 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
9603 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
9604 (www/HTTP)
9605
9606 Field Format Extract from the example above
9607 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
9608 2 'Connect from' Connect from
9609 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
9610 4 'to' to
9611 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
9612 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
9613
9614Detailed fields description :
9615 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
9616 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
9617 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
9618 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
9619 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9620 and processed the connection.
9621 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
9622
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009623In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
9624"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
9625connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
9626
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009627It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
9628will eventually disappear.
9629
9630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096318.2.2. TCP log format
9632---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009633
9634The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
9635is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
9636information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
9637counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
9638emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
9639environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
9640the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
9641sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009642specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
9643not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
9644fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
9645marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009646
9647 Example :
9648 frontend fnt
9649 mode tcp
9650 option tcplog
9651 log global
9652 default_backend bck
9653
9654 backend bck
9655 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9656
9657 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
9658 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
9659 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
9660
9661 Field Format Extract from the example above
9662 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
9663 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
9664 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
9665 4 frontend_name fnt
9666 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
9667 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
9668 7 bytes_read* 212
9669 8 termination_state --
9670 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
9671 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9672
9673Detailed fields description :
9674 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009675 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9676 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9677 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9678 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9679 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009680
9681 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009682 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9683 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9684 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009685
9686 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
9687 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
9688 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
9689 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
9690
9691 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9692 and processed the connection.
9693
9694 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9695 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9696 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
9697 applications.
9698
9699 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9700 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9701 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9702 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
9703 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
9704
9705 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9706 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9707 See "Timers" below for more details.
9708
9709 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9710 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9711 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
9712 "Timers" below for more details.
9713
9714 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9715 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9716 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9717 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9718 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9719 details.
9720
9721 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
9722 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
9723 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
9724 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
9725 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
9726
9727 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9728 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9729 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
9730 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
9731 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
9732 for more details.
9733
9734 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009735 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009736 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
9737 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
9738 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009739 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009740
9741 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9742 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9743 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9744 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9745 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9746 caused by a denial of service attack.
9747
9748 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9749 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9750 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9751 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9752 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9753 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9754 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9755 denial of service attack.
9756
9757 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9758 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9759 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9760 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9761 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9762 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9763 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9764 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
9765 be processed than on other servers.
9766
9767 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9768 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9769 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9770 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9771 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9772 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9773 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9774 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9775 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9776 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9777 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9778 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9779 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9780
9781 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9782 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9783 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9784 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9785 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9786 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9787 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9788 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9789
9790 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9791 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9792 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9793 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9794 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9795 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9796 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9797 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9798 occurs.
9799
9800
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098018.2.3. HTTP log format
9802----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009803
9804The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
9805is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
9806the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
9807are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
9808emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
9809generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
9810"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
9811which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009812frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
9813is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009814
9815Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
9816slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
9817with a star ('*') after the field name below.
9818
9819 Example :
9820 frontend http-in
9821 mode http
9822 option httplog
9823 log global
9824 default_backend bck
9825
9826 backend static
9827 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
9828
9829 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9830 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9831 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009832 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009833
9834 Field Format Extract from the example above
9835 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
9836 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
9837 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
9838 4 frontend_name http-in
9839 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
9840 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
9841 7 status_code 200
9842 8 bytes_read* 2750
9843 9 captured_request_cookie -
9844 10 captured_response_cookie -
9845 11 termination_state ----
9846 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
9847 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
9848 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
9849 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
9850 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009851
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009852
9853Detailed fields description :
9854 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009855 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
9856 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
9857 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
9858 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
9859 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009860
9861 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01009862 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
9863 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
9864 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009865
9866 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
9867 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
9868 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
9869 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
9870 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
9871
9872 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
9873 and processed the connection.
9874
9875 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
9876 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
9877 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
9878
9879 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
9880 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
9881 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
9882 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
9883 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
9884 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
9885
9886 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
9887 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
9888 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
9889 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
9890 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
9891 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
9892
9893 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
9894 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
9895 See "Timers" below for more details.
9896
9897 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
9898 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
9899 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
9900 below for more details.
9901
9902 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
9903 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
9904 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
9905 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
9906 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
9907 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
9908 for more details.
9909
9910 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
9911 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
9912 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
9913 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
9914 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
9915 details.
9916
9917 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
9918 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
9919 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
9920
9921 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
9922 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
9923 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
9924 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
9925 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
9926 overflowing.
9927
9928 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
9929 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
9930 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
9931 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
9932 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
9933 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
9934 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
9935 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9936
9937 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
9938 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
9939 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
9940 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
9941 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
9942 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
9943 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
9944 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
9945
9946 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
9947 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
9948 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
9949 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
9950 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
9951 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
9952 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
9953
9954 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009955 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009956 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
9957 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
9958 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009959 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009960 system.
9961
9962 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
9963 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
9964 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
9965 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
9966 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
9967 caused by a denial of service attack.
9968
9969 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
9970 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
9971 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
9972 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
9973 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
9974 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
9975 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
9976 denial of service attack.
9977
9978 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
9979 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
9980 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
9981 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
9982 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
9983 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9984 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9985 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9986 processed than on other servers.
9987
9988 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9989 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9990 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9991 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9992 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9993 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9994 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9995 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9996 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9997 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9998 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9999 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
10000 should not be attributed to the logged server.
10001
10002 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10003 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
10004 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
10005 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
10006 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
10007 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
10008 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
10009 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
10010
10011 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
10012 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
10013 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
10014 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
10015 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
10016 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
10017 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
10018 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
10019 occurs.
10020
10021 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
10022 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
10023 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
10024 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
10025 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
10026 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
10027 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
10028 cookies" below for more details.
10029
10030 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
10031 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
10032 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
10033 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
10034 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
10035 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
10036 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
10037 and cookies" below for more details.
10038
10039 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
10040 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
10041 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
10042 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
10043 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
10044 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
10045 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
10046 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
10047
10048
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200100498.2.4. Custom log format
10050------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010051
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010052The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
10053mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010054
10055HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
10056Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
10057separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
10058prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
10059
10060Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
10061variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
10062string formats ("Q").
10063
10064Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
10065HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
10066
10067Flags are :
10068 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010069 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010070
10071 Example:
10072
10073 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
10074 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
10075
10076At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
10077
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010078 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +010010079 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010080
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010081the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010082
10083 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010084 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010085 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
10086
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010087and the default TCP format is defined this way :
10088
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010089 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010090 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
10091
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010092Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
10093
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010094 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010095 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010096 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10097 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
10098 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
10099 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010100 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010101 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010102 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +010010103 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010104 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
10105 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
10106 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010107 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010108 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
10109 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
10110 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010111 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080010112 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010113 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
10114 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010115 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010116 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
10117 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
10118 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
10119 | | %b | backend_name | string |
10120 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
10121 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010122 | H | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
10123 | H | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
10124 | H | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010125 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020010126 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010127 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010128 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
10129 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
10130 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
10131 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010132 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010133 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010134 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010135 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
10136 | | %s | server_name | string |
10137 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
10138 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010139 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
10140 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
10141 | H | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020010142 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010143 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010144 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010010145 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010146
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020010147 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010010148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101498.3. Advanced logging options
10150-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010151
10152Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
10153just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
10154options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
10155for more information about their usage.
10156
10157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101588.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
10159------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010160
10161It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
10162haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
10163commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
10164monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
10165ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
10166
10167 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
10168 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
10169 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
10170 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
10171
10172 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
10173 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
10174 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
10175 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
10176 such as other load-balancers.
10177
10178 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
10179 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
10180 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
10181
10182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101838.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
10184----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010185
10186The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
10187what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
10188or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
10189"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
10190just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
10191log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
10192after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
10193is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
10194with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
10195with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
10196
10197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200101988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
10199------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010200
10201Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
10202for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
10203"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
10204retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
10205raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
10206a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
10207file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
10208you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
10209"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
10210
10211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102128.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
10213--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010214
10215Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
10216multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
10217them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
10218"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
10219logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
10220error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
10221and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
10222too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
10223useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
10224alternative.
10225
10226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200102278.4. Timing events
10228------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010229
10230Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
10231reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
10232the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
10233frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
10234mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
10235
10236 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
10237 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
10238 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
10239 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
10240 the client closes prematurely or times out.
10241
10242 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
10243 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
10244 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
10245 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
10246 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
10247
10248 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
10249 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
10250 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
10251 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
10252 connection never established.
10253
10254 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
10255 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
10256 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
10257 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
10258 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
10259 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
10260 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
10261 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
10262 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
10263 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
10264 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
10265
10266 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
10267 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
10268 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
10269 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
10270 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
10271
10272 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
10273
10274 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
10275 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
10276 negative.
10277
10278These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
10279protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
10280that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010281due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010282close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
10283session has been aborted on timeout.
10284
10285Most common cases :
10286
10287 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10288 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
10289 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
10290 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
10291 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
10292 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
10293 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
10294 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
10295 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020010296 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
10297 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
10298 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010299
10300 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
10301 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
10302 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
10303 of ms on remote networks.
10304
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010305 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
10306 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
10307 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010308
10309 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
10310 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
10311 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
10312 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
10313 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
10314 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
10315 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
10316 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
10317 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
10318 to the server until another one is released.
10319
10320Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
10321
10322 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
10323 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
10324 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
10325
10326 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
10327 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
10328 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
10329
10330 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
10331 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
10332 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
10333 flags.
10334
10335 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
10336 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
10337 Check the session termination flags, then check the
10338 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
10339 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
10340 the client connection was maintained open.
10341
10342 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
10343 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
10344 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
10345 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
10346
10347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200103488.5. Session state at disconnection
10349-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010350
10351TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
10352"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
103532-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
10354each of which has a special meaning :
10355
10356 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
10357 session to terminate :
10358
10359 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
10360
10361 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
10362 server explicitly refused it.
10363
10364 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
10365 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
10366 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
10367 error in server response which might have caused information leak
10368 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
10369 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
10370
10371 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
10372 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
10373 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
10374 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
10375 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
10376
10377 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
10378 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
10379 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
10380 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
10381 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
10382
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090010383 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
10384 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
10385
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010386 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
10387 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
10388 backup connections when going up.
10389
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020010390 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
10391
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010392 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
10393 send or receive data.
10394
10395 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
10396 send or receive data.
10397
10398 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
10399 with nothing left in the buffers.
10400
10401 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
10402
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010010403 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010404 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
10405
10406 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
10407 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
10408 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
10409 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
10410 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
10411
10412 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
10413 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
10414
10415 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
10416 server (HTTP only).
10417
10418 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
10419
10420 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
10421 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
10422 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
10423
10424 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
10425 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
10426 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
10427
10428 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
10429
10430 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
10431 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
10432
10433 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
10434 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
10435 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
10436
10437 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
10438 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020010439 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
10440 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010441
10442 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
10443 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
10444 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
10445 another server.
10446
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010447 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010448 server.
10449
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010450 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
10451 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
10452 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
10453 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10454
10455 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
10456 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
10457 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
10458 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
10459
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020010460 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
10461 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
10462 "use-server" rule).
10463
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010464 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10465
10466 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
10467 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
10468
10469 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
10470
10471 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
10472 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
10473 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
10474
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010475 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
10476 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
10477 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
10478 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
10479 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
10480
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010481 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
10482
10483 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
10484 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
10485
10486 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
10487
10488 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
10489
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010490The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
10491was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010492helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
10493starvation, attacks, etc...
10494
10495The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
10496alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
10497easier finding and understanding.
10498
10499 Flags Reason
10500
10501 -- Normal termination.
10502
10503 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
10504 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
10505 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
10506 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
10507
10508 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
10509 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
10510 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
10511 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
10512 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
10513 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010514
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010515 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10516 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010517 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010518
10519 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
10520 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
10521 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
10522
10523 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
10524 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
10525 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
10526 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
10527 the server takes too long to respond.
10528
10529 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
10530 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
10531 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
10532 long a time to respond.
10533
10534 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
10535 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
10536 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
10537 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
10538 and the client.
10539
10540 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
10541 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
10542 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
10543 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
10544 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
10545 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
10546
10547 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
10548 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010549 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
10550 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
10551 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
10552 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010553
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010554 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010555 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
10556 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
10557 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
10558 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
10559 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
10560
10561 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
10562 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
10563 503 or 504 here.
10564
10565 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
10566 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
10567 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
10568 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
10569 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
10570
10571 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
10572 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010573 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010574 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
10575 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
10576
10577 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
10578 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
10579 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
10580 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
10581 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
10582 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
10583 between haproxy and the server.
10584
10585 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
10586 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
10587 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
10588 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
10589 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
10590 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
10591 solution is to fix the application.
10592
10593 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
10594 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
10595 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
10596 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
10597 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
10598 external attacks.
10599
10600 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
10601 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010602 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010603 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
10604 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
10605
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010606 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
10607 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
10608 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
10609 the client.
10610
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010611 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
10612 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
10613 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
10614 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010010615 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
10616 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
10617 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
10618 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
10619 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010620
10621 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
10622 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
10623 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
10624 returned an HTTP 403 error.
10625
10626 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
10627 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
10628 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
10629 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
10630
10631 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
10632 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
10633 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
10634 only be solved by proper system tuning.
10635
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010636The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
10637persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
10638important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
10639re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
10640
10641 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
10642
10643 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10644 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
10645 set on a GET request.
10646
10647 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
10648 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010649 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020010650 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
10651
10652 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
10653 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
10654 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
10655
10656 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
10657 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
10658 already got a cookie.
10659
10660 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10661 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
10662 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
10663 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
10664 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
10665
10666 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
10667 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10668 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10669
10670 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
10671 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
10672 new cookie was inserted in the response.
10673
10674 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
10675 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
10676
10677 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
10678 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
10679 then advertised in the response.
10680
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200106828.6. Non-printable characters
10683-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010684
10685In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
10686consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
10687converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
10688prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
10689being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
10690escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
10691is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
10692'}' when logging headers.
10693
10694Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
10695issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
10696containing spaces is "User-Agent".
10697
10698Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
10699the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
10700performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
10701
10702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
10704---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010705
10706Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
10707achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010708section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010709cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
10710the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
10711the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010712locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010713not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
10714user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
10715a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
10716wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
10717
10718 Examples :
10719 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
10720 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
10721
10722 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
10723 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
10724
10725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200107268.8. Capturing HTTP headers
10727---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010728
10729Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
10730proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
10731the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
10732server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
10733
10734Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
10735response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010736section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010737
10738It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010739time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
10740appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010741are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
10742and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
10743follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
10744request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
10745in the logs.
10746
10747 Example :
10748 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
10749 listen proxy-out
10750 mode http
10751 option httplog
10752 option logasap
10753 log global
10754 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
10755
10756 # log the name of the virtual server
10757 capture request header Host len 20
10758
10759 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
10760 capture request header Content-Length len 10
10761
10762 # log the beginning of the referrer
10763 capture request header Referer len 20
10764
10765 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
10766 capture response header Server len 20
10767
10768 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
10769 capture response header Content-Length len 10
10770
10771 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
10772 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
10773
10774 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
10775 capture response header Via len 20
10776
10777 # log the URL location during a redirection
10778 capture response header Location len 20
10779
10780 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
10781 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
10782 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10783 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
10784 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
10785
10786 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10787 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10788 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10789 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010790 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010791
10792 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
10793 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
10794 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
10795 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
10796 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010797 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010798
10799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108008.9. Examples of logs
10801---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010802
10803These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
10804them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
10805reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
10806
10807 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
10808 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10809 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10810
10811 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
10812 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
10813
10814 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
10815 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
10816 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
10817
10818 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
10819 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
10820
10821 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
10822 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
10823 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10824
10825 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010826 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010827 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
10828 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
10829
10830 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
10831 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
10832 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
10833
10834 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
10835 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010836 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010837 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
10838 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
10839 to return the 502 and not the server.
10840
10841 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010842 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010843
10844 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
10845 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
10846 Nothing was sent to any server.
10847
10848 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
10849 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
10850
10851 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
10852 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
10853 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
10854 send a 408 return code to the client.
10855
10856 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
10857 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
10858
10859 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
10860 5 seconds ("c----").
10861
10862 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
10863 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010864 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010865
10866 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010867 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010868 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
10869 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
10870 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
10871 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
10872 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010873
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010874
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200108759. Statistics and monitoring
10876----------------------------
10877
10878It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
10879mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
10880CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
10881Unix socket.
10882
10883
108849.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010885---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010886
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010010887The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
10888page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
10889
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010890 0. pxname: proxy name
10891 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
10892 for server)
10893 2. qcur: current queued requests
10894 3. qmax: max queued requests
10895 4. scur: current sessions
10896 5. smax: max sessions
10897 6. slim: sessions limit
10898 7. stot: total sessions
10899 8. bin: bytes in
10900 9. bout: bytes out
10901 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010902 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010903 12. ereq: request errors
10904 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010905 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010906 15. wretr: retries (warning)
10907 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010010908 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010010909 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
10910 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
10911 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
10912 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
10913 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
10914 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
10915 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
10916 25. qlimit: queue limit
10917 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
10918 27. iid: unique proxy id
10919 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
10920 29. throttle: warm up status
10921 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
10922 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010923 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020010924 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
10925 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
10926 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010927 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010928 UNK -> unknown
10929 INI -> initializing
10930 SOCKERR -> socket error
10931 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
10932 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
10933 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
10934 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
10935 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
10936 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10937 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10938 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
10939 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
10940 disable-on-404
10941 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10942 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10943 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020010944 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
10945 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010946 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
10947 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
10948 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
10949 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
10950 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
10951 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010952 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
10953 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
10954 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
10955 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010010956 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
10957 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010958
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200109609.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010961-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010962
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010963The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010964must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
10965is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
10966a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
10967risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
10968followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
10969given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
10970then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
10971to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010972
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010973It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
10974on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
10975own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010976
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010977clear counters
10978 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
10979 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
10980 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
10981 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
10982 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10983
10984clear counters all
10985 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
10986 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
10987 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
10988
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010989clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
10990 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
10991
10992 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10993 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10994 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10995 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10996 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10997 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10998
10999 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
11000
11001 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
11002 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
11003 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
11004 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
11005 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
11006 the ACLs :
11007
11008 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11009 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11010 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11011 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11012 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11013 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11014
11015 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011016 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
11017 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011018
11019 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011020 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011021 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011022 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11023 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11024 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11025 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011026
11027 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11028
11029 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011030 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011031 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11032 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011033 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11034 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11035 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011036
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011037disable frontend <frontend>
11038 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
11039 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
11040 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
11041 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
11042 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
11043 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
11044 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
11045 on the stats page.
11046
11047 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11048 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11049
11050 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11051 level "admin".
11052
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011053disable server <backend>/<server>
11054 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
11055 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
11056 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
11057 during the maintenance.
11058
11059 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
11060 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
11061
11062 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011063 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011064
11065 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11066 level "admin".
11067
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011068enable frontend <frontend>
11069 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
11070 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
11071 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
11072 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
11073 which was disabled.
11074
11075 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11076 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11077
11078 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11079 level "admin".
11080
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011081enable server <backend>/<server>
11082 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
11083 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
11084
11085 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011086 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011087
11088 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11089 level "admin".
11090
11091get weight <backend>/<server>
11092 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
11093 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
11094 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
11095 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
11096 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011097 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011098
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011099help
11100 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
11101 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010011102
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011103prompt
11104 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
11105 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
11106 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
11107 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
11108 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
11109 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
11110 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
11111 command.
11112
11113quit
11114 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011115
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011116set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020011117 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
11118 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
11119 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
11120 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
11121 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020011122 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
11123 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11124
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020011125set maxconn global <maxconn>
11126 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
11127 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
11128 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
11129 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
11130 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
11131 setting.
11132
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020011133set rate-limit connections global <value>
11134 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
11135 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
11136 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
11137 is passed in number of connections per second.
11138
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010011139set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
11140 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
11141 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
11142 passed in number of kilobytes per second.
11143
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020011144set table <table> key <key> data.<data_type> <value>
11145 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
11146 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
11147 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
11148 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
11149 IP address or affect its quality of service.
11150
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011151set timeout cli <delay>
11152 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
11153 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
11154 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
11155
11156set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
11157 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
11158 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
11159 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
11160 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
11161 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
11162 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
11163 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
11164 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
11165 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
11166 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
11167 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
11168 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
11169 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020011170 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011171
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011172show errors [<iid>]
11173 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
11174 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011175 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
11176 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
11177 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011178
11179 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
11180 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
11181 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
11182 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
11183 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
11184 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
11185 are reported too.
11186
11187 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
11188 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
11189 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
11190 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
11191 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
11192 code.
11193
11194 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
11195 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
11196 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
11197 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
11198 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
11199 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
11200 line.
11201
11202 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011203 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
11204 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011205 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
11206 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
11207
11208 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
11209 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
11210 00038 Location: blah\r\n
11211 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
11212 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
11213 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
11214 00204+ minal\r\n
11215 00211 \r\n
11216
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011217 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010011218 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
11219 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
11220 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
11221 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
11222 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
11223 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010011224
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011225show info
11226 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
11227
11228show sess
11229 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020011230 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
11231 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
11232
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010011233show sess <id>
11234 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
11235 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11236 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
11237 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
11238 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
11239 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011240
11241show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
11242 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
11243 possible to dump only selected items :
11244 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
11245 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
11246 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
11247 for example:
11248 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
11249 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
11250 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
11251
11252 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011253 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
11254 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011255 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
11256 Release_date: 2009/09/23
11257 Nbproc: 1
11258 Process_num: 1
11259 (...)
11260
11261 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
11262 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
11263 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
11264 (...)
11265 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
11266
11267 $
11268
11269 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
11270 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
11271 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
11272 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011273 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020011274
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011275show table
11276 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
11277 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
11278 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
11279 entries currently in use.
11280
11281 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011282 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011283 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
11284 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011285
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011286show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011287 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
11288 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
11289 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011290 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
11291
11292 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
11293 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
11294 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
11295 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
11296 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
11297
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011298 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
11299 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
11300 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
11301 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
11302 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
11303 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
11304
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090011305
11306 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090011307 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
11308 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011309
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011310 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011311 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011312 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011313 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
11314 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
11315 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11316 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011317
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011318 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011319 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011320 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11321 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011322
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011323 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
11324 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011325 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011326 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11327 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011328
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011329 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
11330 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090011331 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090011332 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
11333 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
11334
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011335 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
11336 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
11337 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
11338 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
11339 time goes, the average event rate drops.
11340
11341 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
11342 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
11343 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020011344 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
11345 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020011346 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
11347 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020011348
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020011349shutdown frontend <frontend>
11350 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
11351 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
11352 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
11353 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
11354 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
11355 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
11356 once it is terminated.
11357
11358 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
11359 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
11360
11361 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
11362 level "admin".
11363
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020011364shutdown session <id>
11365 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
11366 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
11367 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
11368 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
11369 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
11370 flag in the logs.
11371
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020011372shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
11373 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
11374 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
11375 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
11376 'K' flag in the logs.
11377
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011378/*
11379 * Local variables:
11380 * fill-column: 79
11381 * End:
11382 */